Silicon ChipAugust 2010 - Silicon Chip Online SILICON CHIP
  1. Outer Front Cover
  2. Contents
  3. Publisher's Letter: Big business is driving the push for a carbon price
  4. Feature: Solar Power When The Sun Doesn’t Shine by Richard Keech & Matthew Wright
  5. Feature: Flat-Panel TV 42 Years Ago by Electronics Australia
  6. Review: Quad HiFi Gear: How It Stacks Up 30 Years On by Nicholas Vinen
  7. Project: High-Power Reversible DC Motor Speed Controller by Branko Justic
  8. Project: Remote-Controlled Digital Up/Down Timer by Nicholas Vinen
  9. Project: Build A Large Ultrasonic Cleaner by John Clarke
  10. Review: Hameg HMF2550 Arbitrary Function Generator by Nicholas Vinen
  11. Project: Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer & Tester by Jim Rowe
  12. Vintage Radio: The Airzone 612 6-valve battery-powered console by Rodney Champness
  13. Vintage Radio: The Fifth National Radio & Phono Fest by Kevin Poulter
  14. Book Store
  15. Advertising Index
  16. Outer Back Cover

This is only a preview of the August 2010 issue of Silicon Chip.

You can view 31 of the 104 pages in the full issue, including the advertisments.

For full access, purchase the issue for $10.00 or subscribe for access to the latest issues.

Items relevant to "Remote-Controlled Digital Up/Down Timer":
  • Remote-Controlled Digital Up/Down Timer PCB [19108101] (AUD $10.00)
  • ATtiny2313 programmed for the Remote-Controlled Digital Up/Down Timer [1910810B.HEX] (Programmed Microcontroller, AUD $15.00)
  • Firmware for the Digital Up/Down Timer [1910810B.HEX] (Software, Free)
  • Remote-Controlled Digital Up/Down Timer PCB pattern (PDF download) [19108101] (Free)
  • Remote-Controlled Digital Up/Down Timer PCB pattern (PDF download) [19108102] (Free)
Items relevant to "Build A Large Ultrasonic Cleaner":
  • PIC12F675-I/P programmed for the Ultrasonic Cleaner [0420810A.HEX] (Programmed Microcontroller, AUD $10.00)
  • ETD29 transformer components (AUD $15.00)
  • Firmware for the Ultrasonic Cleaner [0420810A.HEX] (Software, Free)
  • Ultrasonic Cleaner PCB pattern (PDF download) [04208101] (Free)
  • Ultrasonic Cleaner front panel design (PDF download) (Panel Artwork, Free)
Items relevant to "Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer & Tester":
  • Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer & Tester PCB [04108101] (AUD $20.00)
  • PIC16F88-I/P programmed for the Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer and Tester [0410810A.HEX] (Programmed Microcontroller, AUD $15.00)
  • Firmware for the Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer [0410810A.HEX] (Software, Free)
  • Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer PCB pattern (PDF download) [04108101] (Free)
  • Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer front panel design (PDF download) (Panel Artwork, Free)
Articles in this series:
  • Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer & Tester (August 2010)
  • Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer & Tester (August 2010)
  • Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer & Tester, Pt.2 (September 2010)
  • Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer & Tester, Pt.2 (September 2010)

Purchase a printed copy of this issue for $10.00.

SILICON CHIP 24/7 Solar Power Generation: Generation: how it’s done AUGUST 2010 ISSN 1030-2662 11 9 771030 266001 PRINT POST APPROVED - PP255003/01272 8 $ 95* NZ $ 11 00 INC GST INC GST Remote-controlled 1 second - 100 hour Digital Up/Down Timer We test 30-year-old QUAD Electrostatics: Do they deserve their legendary reputation? Ultrasonic Cleaning Tank for siliconchip.com.au Larger Objects Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer A 2010  1 and Tester ugust 24 -12V DC-DC Converter 10A with Cig In/Out MR16 CREE Downlights DEALS TO WARM DC to DC converters are useful for running 12V devices from a 24V supply in a truck or bus. These have switchmode technology for light weight & compact design. Input & output is via cigarette lighter plug & socket. • Input voltage: 20 - 30VDC • Output voltage: 13.8VDC • Output current: 7A continuous, 10A max. • Efficiency: 85% • Dimensions: 160(L) x 48(W) x 48(H)mm MP-3352 WAS $69.95 59 95 $ SAVE 10 00 $ 4 Port HDMI Switcher with SPDIF/Coaxial Audio Splitter HDMI integrates audio and video signals, however it results in less than optimal audio output. This 4 port HDMI switcher separates the audio signal from the HDMI interface and transmits it to an amplifier by SPDIF or coaxial (RCA). Remote included. • 4 x HDMI inputs, 1 x HDMI output with coax and SPDIF audio output • HDMI 1.3b compliant • HDTV 1080p resolution • Amplifier bandwidth 2.25Gbps/225MHz • Dimensions: 155(W) x 70(D) x 23(H)mm AC-1625 119 00 $ YOU UP THIS WINTER! Designed for long life, and using the latest in high intensity technology, these MR16 downlights pump out brilliant lumens of white light. MR16 3 x 2W Cool White • Lumens: 450 • Colour temperature: White 5000 - 7000k • Lens:38 degree $64 95 • Dimensions: 50(D) x 63(L)mm SAVE ZD-0353 WAS $74.95 MR16 3 x 2W Warm White • Lumens: 310 • Colour temp: 2700 - 3500k • Lens: 38 degree • Dimensions: 50(Dia) x 63(L)mm ZD-0354 WAS $74.95 $ 95 10 00 $ 64 SAVE Vifa D25AG Tweeter 10 00 $ Over the last 20 years this iconic tweeter has found its way into countless OEM hi-fi, home theatre designs and high end speaker kits. Features an aluminium alloy diaphragm with high precision phase shield and butterfly voice coil assembly with Ferro fluid cooling to ensure high power handling. A double chamber also provides a resonant frequency of 850Hz. Add one to your project or give your current speakers a new lease of life. • Power handling: 100WRMS • Nominal impedance: 6 ohms CT-2020 69 95 $ Solar Powered LED Bicycle Tail Light This solar powered tail light is a simple and versatile addition to your night riding equipment. The solar cell charges the two AAA batteries during the day giving you enough power to ride for hours at night. The device uses 4 red LEDs that blink in unison creating an easily visible beacon to cars and trucks. • Weight: 73g (with batteries) • Measures: 64(W) x $12 95 65(H)mm SAVE ST-3276 WAS $23.95 11 00 $ HDMI Over Cat 5/6 Extender Most HDMI over Cat 5/6 extenders available uses two cables for data and signal transmission. This extender only utilises one Cat 5/6 cable reducing the cable costs further on transmission over great distances. Both unshielded twisted pair (UTP) and shielded twisted pair (STP) cables may be used, however shielded is recommended. AC-1681 149 00 $ HDMI Leads with Extender Normally you can't run an HDMI cable over a maximum of about 5 metres without using a booster. These cables solve this problem by adding an extender to give you a range of 15 or 20m with no need for additional power. The connectors have gold plated contacts. HDMI 1.3 and HDCP compliant. 10m HDMI Lead with Extender - WQ-7403 $99.00 15m HDMI Lead with Extender - WQ-7408 $139.00 20m HDMI Lead with Extender - WQ-7409 $199.00 2.4GHz Wireless Headphone USB Transmitter These headphones use state-of-the-art digital audio technology to receive 2.4GHz signals from the USB transmitter (provided) which easily plugs into a desktop computer or notebook. The signals can come from TV, DVD/ DVB, CD player or MP3 players. • 92dB audio dynamic range • Operating at 2.4GHz ISM band with 8 selectable channels • USB transmitter compatible with Windows OS 98SE/Me/2000/XP • Requires 2 x AA batteries $69 95 AA-2035 WAS $99.95 SAVE 30 00 $ Home Theatre Powerboard Surge protection and filtering is provided to all your home theatre equipment connected to this powerboard as well as current protection via the in-built circuit breaker. • Provides protection to telephone, data via a network connection, satellite/cable TV and TV aerials. MS-4024 WAS $64.95 49 95 $ SAVE 15 00 $ To order call 1800 022 888 www.jaycar.com.au Prices valid until 23/08/2010. While stocks last. No rainchecks. Savings are based on ORRP. Wallplate with VGA / 2 x RCA Sockets VGA and 2 x RCA sockets for stereo audio and video. PT-0478 27 95 $ Powerboards 8 Way High End Powerboard with Surge Protection Ideal for home theatre and any other application where you have high-end gear connected. Surge protection and filtering are provided for the mains power to all your equipment and each socket is protected through active, neutral and earth. Additional protection is provided by the built-in circuit breaker. This powerboard also has telephone protection (1 input, two outputs so doubles as a splitter), data protection for a network connection, satellite / cable TV video protection, and protection for the TV antenna. $50,000 Connected Equipment Warranty. See website for details. MS-4029 WAS $99.95 89 95 $ SAVE 10 00 $ Contents Vol.23, No.8; August 2010 SILICON CHIP www.siliconchip.com.au Features 10 Solar Power When The Sun Doesn’t Shine Here’s how the Spanish get solar power around the clock using advances in thermal storage – by Richard Keech & Matthew Wright 16 Flat-Panel TV 42 Years Ago If you thought flat-screen TV was a recent innovation, check out this article from “Electronics Australia” 42 years ago! High-Power Reversible DC Motor Controller – Page 26. 26. 20 Quad HiFi Gear: How It Stacks Up 30 Years On Quad gear was revered by hifi enthusiasts from the 1950s to the 1980s. So how well does it stack up against modern hifi gear? – by Nicholas Vinen 72 Review: Hameg HMF2550 Arbitrary Function Generator This unit can deliver a 14-bit arbitrary waveform at 250MS/s, a sine or square wave up to 50MHz or a triangle wave up to 10MHz. It also does PWM, FSK and more – by Nicholas Vinen Pro jects To Build 26 High-Power Reversible DC Motor Speed Controller It’s available in reversible and non-reversible versions and features soft start, relay switching of motor direction and PWM speed control – by Branko Justic 34 Remote-Controlled Digital Up/Down Timer Remote-Controlled Digital Up/Down Timer – Page 34. This versatile timer can count up or down from one second to 100 hours and is programmed using a universal infrared remote control. It can also be automatically controlled by external trigger inputs – by Nicholas Vinen 58 Build A Large Ultrasonic Cleaner Looking for a large ultrasonic cleaner at low cost? This unit is ideal for cleaning automotive and other large mechanical parts – by John Clarke 80 Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer & Tester Got a bunch of old electrolytic capacitors you’d like to use . . . but don’t know if they are any good? Or do you need to re-form the electrolytics in an old valve amplifier or vintage radio set? This unit will do the job – by Jim Rowe Special Columns 44 Serviceman’s Log Consumer gear that’s faulty out of the box – by the Serviceman 67 Circuit Notebook (1) Check Inductors With This Simple Q-Meter; (2) Adding Protection Diodes To Positive/Negative Regulator Circuits; (3) DC Motor Speed Sensing Circuit; (4) SCR Circuits Based On Discrete Transistors; (5) Playing Dice Games With A PICAXE08M; (6) Random Playback Trigger For The Voice Recorder Build A Large Ultrasonic Cleaner – Page 58. 88 Vintage Radio The Airzone 612 6-valve battery-powered console – by Rodney Champness Departments   2   4 25 57 Publisher’s Letter Mailbag Order Form Product Showcase siliconchip.com.au 94 Ask Silicon Chip 98 Notes & Errata 102 Market Centre Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer & Tester – Page 80. August 2010  1 SILICON SILIC CHIP www.siliconchip.com.au Publisher & Editor-in-Chief Leo Simpson, B.Bus., FAICD Production Manager Greg Swain, B.Sc. (Hons.) Technical Editor John Clarke, B.E.(Elec.) Technical Staff Ross Tester Jim Rowe, B.A., B.Sc Mauro Grassi, B.Sc. (Hons), Ph.D Nicholas Vinen Photography Ross Tester Reader Services Ann Morris Advertising Enquiries Glyn Smith Phone (02) 9939 3295 Mobile 0431 792 293 glyn<at>siliconchip.com.au Regular Contributors Brendan Akhurst Rodney Champness, VK3UG Kevin Poulter Mike Sheriff, B.Sc, VK2YFK Stan Swan SILICON CHIP is published 12 times a year by Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd. ACN 003 205 490. ABN 49 003 205 490. All material is copyright ©. No part of this publication may be reproduced without the written consent of the publisher. Printing: Hannanprint, Noble Park, Victoria. Distribution: Network Distribution Company. Subscription rates: $94.50 per year in Australia. For overseas rates, see the order form in this issue. Editorial office: Unit 1, 234 Harbord Rd, Brookvale, NSW 2100. Postal address: PO Box 139, Collaroy Beach, NSW 2097. Phone (02) 9939 3295. Fax (02) 9939 2648. E-mail: silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au ISSN 1030-2662 Recommended and maximum price only. 2  Silicon Chip Publisher’s Letter Big business is driving the push for a carbon price As most readers will be aware, Australians have two major concerns about energy and energy prices. The largest group would appear to be those who are concerned about the ever-increasing prices for energy, whether it be for electricity, gas, petrol or dieseline. This concern is real and prices are set to go up at an ever-increasing rate, particularly for electricity, because of the lack of new power stations being built and the increasing subsidies being offered to costly renewable energy sources such as wind and solar power. The other group of Australians who are concerned about energy prices are those who are actively promoting the idea of a “carbon price”, particularly now that the Australian government has postponed any immediate action on climate change or an emissions trading scheme (ETS). Probably you think that “green” politicians are behind this push and it is true that there is quite a lot of coverage of the statements made by green groups in the media. However, it is not the greens who are doing most of the pushing – it is big business. To get an idea of the big business push, you only have to look at “Carbon Expo Australasia 2010” planned for Melbourne in October this year. It is supposedly aimed at “energising the low carbon economy”. Now you might think that this is all about “feel good” stuff like installing solar panels on your roof and using waterless toilets but you would be wrong. You only have to look at the list of businesses and business groups involved to have serious misgivings. A partial list includes the Carbon Markets & Investors Association, Investors Group on Climate Change, Environmental Business Australia, Asia-Pacific Investors Trading Forum, AGL and Bloomberg New Energy Finance. These people are involved because they can see big opportunities to make lots of money if the government can be persuaded to bring in a carbon price or carbon taxes. If either of these do eventuate, energy prices can be expected to go up at an even faster rate. Last year’s CarbonExpo conference was seen as a build-up to the Copenhagen Conference which ended in disarray. The moderator at one of the sessions at CarbonExpo last year was Dr Rajendra Pachauri – he is the same person who claimed that all the Himalayan glaciers would melt within 30 years! Nobody is giving that any credence any more. You can download the draft program for this year’s conference at http://carbonexpo.com.au/uploads/file/2010/2010DraftProgram2406.pdf and there you can see that they plan to discuss matters such as “raising finance for low carbon projects from institutional investors”, “the state of carbon markets”, “Interaction with Asia – issues and opportunities for interacting with Asia as the region transitions to a low-carbon economy”, “Carbon capture & storage”, biofuels and so on. None of this is good news for people concerned about increasing energy prices. It is all about looking for new ways to make money – lots of it and governmentmandated to boot. In the session entitled “Australia’s role in international action & markets” they will include consideration of: a science update – how has the science shaped up over the last 12 months? What is science’s latest view of the emissions reduction imperative? How has science responded to the rise of climate change scepticism – in terms of content & process? Can the carbon market expect increased support from strengthened climate change science? Does this sound like a balanced forum? It seems that unless there are big changes in the political scene in Australia, we will be paying much, much more for energy in the near future. Leo Simpson siliconchip.com.au This is NOT a USB Oscilloscope! It is a 50MHz, 3-channel full-featured ’scope you can hold in the palm of your hand! Just add a monitor and mouse (no PC needed)! Se Screene the review Scope i SILICONn Jan 2010 CHIP! THE A-351 SCREENSCOPE IS A GENUINE STAND-ALONE, REAL-TIME OSCILLOSCOPE: DO NOT CONFUSE WITH INFERIOR USB SCOPES! Here’s what you get:            A genuine digital scope that is ready in seconds! 50MHz 240MSPS real-time sampling 3 channels - 2x 8-bit and 1x 1-bit input FFT in dBVrms, dBm (50, 75, 100, 300 600 Ohm termination) with selectable window +, --, x and. -- math functions and memories . Auto and manual measurements using markers USB host - save waveforms as .txt or .csv Save screen shots as .bmp Easy fast uploads of new firmware revisions Perfect with widescreen monitors (but fine with just about any old computer monitor!) Very easy operation - just single mouse clicks for controls and you can easily move waveforms and objects directly  And so much more (see our website for full specs) NEW:  XY MODE! Introducing ScreenScope - the new type of scope you are going to love to take anywhere and use anywhere. All you need is a mouse and virtually any computer monitor. You don’t need a PC and it’s fun to use! And just look at the low, low price: ONLY $539 (inc GST) with a money-back guarantee! CALL NOW: (03) 9714 8269 www.screenscopetraces.com MAILBAG Letters and emails should contain complete name, address and daytime phone number. Letters to the Editor are submitted on the condition that Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd may edit and has the right to reproduce in electronic form and communicate these letters. This also applies to submissions to “Ask SILICON CHIP” and “Circuit Notebook”. Most older homes do not have RCDs fitted In the letter “Foil Insulation & CFLs”, Mr Pierson (Mailbag, June 2010) asked where the RCDs were if it’s compulsory to have them fitted. The answer is surprisingly simple. When I last worked in the private maintenance sector 4-5 years ago, it was compulsory for all new houses to have them fitted during construction. Any maintenance work on the electricals in existing houses had to have them fitted if they were not already installed. There are quite a lot of older houses where no electrical work has been done since that rule has come into effect so that means that those houses do not have RCDs fitted yet. I lost count of the number of RCD units I fitted when in the maintenance sector but there always seemed to be more switchboards to be upgraded. Brad Coleman, Brisbane, Qld. Mains surge suppressors & warranty claims Over the past year, I have noticed that many of the large retailers of TV All fluorescent tubes contain mercury I read your article entitled “Slash Your Factory/Office Lighting Bills” on the May 2010 issue with interest. However, on page 19 you indicated with the picture of the NEC fluorescent tube that the absence of the “HG” (mercury) marking on the quad-phosphor means that no mercury is present in this new tube. This appears to be misleading and requires further clarification. I believe that HG on the product is defined as “High Grade” on the NEC fluorescent tube and does not indicate mercury (Hg). In the Peri- 4  Silicon Chip sets are advising that either warranties and/or insurance claims will be rejected if you do not use a mains surge suppressor, which of course they have available at a price. I was surprised a few days ago that one such retailer had a surge suppressor sitting on top of each washing machine and when I asked if they included one with each washing machine I was told once again that they were available at additional cost and that unless you used one with the machine, warranties and insurance claims would be rejected. I have just checked with my insurance company and they say that using a surge suppressor has no effect on their insurance conditions, which are defined as electrical damage caused by lightning either directly on the equipment or due to lightning causing a surge in the mains supply. If a surge in the mains supply is not due to lightning (which has to be determined by a technician or by meteorological records), they advise you to contact your electricity supplier. Since all TV sets now use either LCD or plasma screens and most washing machines are electronically odic Table, mercury is specified as Hg where the “g” is lower case (small letter alphabet) as opposed to upper case (capital letter alphabet). I picked up one tube to analyse the labelling that you mentioned. On the paper sleeve packing of the NEC fluorescent tube, it stated HG as “High Grade” and not as mercury. HG is Tri-Phosphor and the HGX is designed to be used for electronic ballast units. X series is QuadPhosphor but note that both X and HG has a 5000K colour temperature, even though one is Tri-Phosphor and the other is a Quad-Phosphor type. I am yet to come across a fluorescent tube that has no mercury controlled, I wonder why the manufacturers don’t build in surge suppressors if mains surges are such a problem. I am inclined to think that it may have more to do with adding to the retailers sales (like extended warranty). I wonder what other readers have found when shopping for home appliances and whether there are some valid warranty or insurance claims that have been rejected because no mains surge suppressor was used. R. Sanders, Kiama, NSW. Comment: any retailer pushing the sale of mains surge suppressors on the grounds of possible warranty claim rejections would appear to be on shaky legal ground. As a first point, you could argue that the dealers are selling equipment which they know is not of “merchantable quality” if there is a danger that mains surges will blow it. All electronic equipment intended for use with the 230VAC mains should be able to withstand normal surges and will typically have MOVs (metal oxide varistors) in although modern fluorescent tubes do contain negligible amounts. A manufacturer can produce a mercury-free fluorescent tube by substituting aluminium trichloride which when energised produces a plasma discharge that emits ultraviolet and visible radiation. Phosphor, in the form of a particulate layer or a gas, converts the ultraviolet into visible light. So it can be done but the cost involved will be very much higher. Michael Ong, Wembley, WA. Comment: you are quite correct. The reference to mercury in that caption is a mistake. siliconchip.com.au LED Lighting - Saving Energy & the Environment Solid-State LED Tube The friendlier alternative to fluorescent lamps Possible vintage radio restoration project We found this old HF two-way radio at the bottom of the Torrens River in Adelaide near the Southwark Brewery. The river was dry during summer, the second time in 40 years. A 2.178MHz crystal was found inside and was the only thing still working (made in the UK). Note the valve still inside, although air has entered the tube. We couldn’t find any identifying markings on the radio. Any reader feedback would be good. We are thinking it would be a good restoration project. HaHa. Dom Martucci, Adelaide, SA. Comment: is there any reader out there who feels like rising to the challenge? Er, perhaps not. their power supplies to provide protection. Second, if there is such a condition in the warranty, the dealer should be able to refer you to it. Third, it is just possible that some of the extended warranties sold by dealers do have such a condition but again, it would need to be highlighted to the potential customer. Having said that, there is nothing wrong with connecting valuable appliances via a mains surge suppressor to provide extra protection. However, we would be wary about using them with washing machines as their induction motors have high surge currents in normal use and these may trip any current overload device in the surge suppressor unit. Finally, while we understand that retailers often make very little margin on major electrical and electronic equipment and therefore try to make more profit by selling all sorts of accessories, there should be no compulsion on the customer to purchase these devices. No mercury, no lead, environmentally friendly Less power, Longer life, Less maintenance Can retrofit T8 Fluorescent Lamps No flicker, steady state lighting AlumLED Lights Modular System DC Lights in aluminium case For showcase lighting, shelf lighting, under cupboard lighting and other applications. Flexible LED Lights RGB Multi-colour, White, Warm White. 24VDC. Cut to length. Remote controls for colour & dimming. Switchmode supplies cause mains waveform distortion Your article on electronic ballasts for fluorescent lighting (SILICON CHIP, May 2010) did not mention the possible introduction of harmonics to the mains. I work in an office with a large number of PCs fed from a large 3-phase inverter. Some time ago, an electrician working siliconchip.com.au With waterproof seal and adhesive taping (non-seal version also available) Website: www.tenrod.com.au E-mail: sales<at>tenrod.com.au Sydney: Melbourne: Brisbane: Auckland: Tel. 02 9748 0655 Tel. 03 9886 7800 Tel. 07 3879 2133 Tel 09 298 4346 Fax. 02 9748 0258 Fax. 03 9886 7799 Fax. 07 3879 2188 Fax. 09 353 1317 August 2010  5 60% On SSave ave Up Up To To 60% On Electronic C Electronic Components omponents New LPC2368 Controller Only $80.38 LPC2368 Microcontroller *Includes with 512kB Flash Memory *USB, LAN, CAN, SPI, I2C, LCD Connections ADC and DAC On-Board * 6SDChannel Card Connector for Data Storage * New Radio Data Transceivers * Standard 433MHz PLL Based * Range Up to 300m Rates Up to 115K bps * Data Works with most * Microcontrollers Only $9.08 Starting from $1.38 Expanded Range of Solar Cells Range of Miniature Solar Cells * Huge Ideal for Projects and Experimentation * Also in Stock Solar Regulators and * Dual Battery Chargers We are your one-stop shop for Microcontroller Boards, PCB Manufacture and Electronic Components www.futurlec.com.au www.futurlec.com.au Mailbag: continued in the switchboard feeding the PCs brushed up against the neutral wire and noticed that it was warm. A current meter showed that it was carrying about 100A; more than any of the Active phases. The electrician could not explain this but fixed the problem with a larger gauge Neutral wire. Later, I found out that this large Neutral current was caused by the third harmonic distortions created by the PCs’ switchmode power supplies. In a balanced 3-phase system, the fundamental frequencies will cancel each other out in the Neutral. However the third harmonics will add together to produce a significant Neutral current. I do not believe that this is well-known and may be a problem in older 3-phase installations where the Neutral wire would sometimes be smaller than the Active phase wires. It would be interesting if you were able to measure the mains distortion produced by electronic ballasts, since if it were significant, it could present a problem in a large installation with the lighting spread over three phases. Mark Baker, South Perth, WA. Comment: most switchmode power supplies do cause considerable distortion of the mains waveform because they take their current from the peak of the waveform. 6  Silicon Chip That is why the peaks of the sinewave are often clipped. However, our current waveform for the electronic ballast shows a reasonable sinewave (see Fig.2, page 14, May 2010), albeit with a relatively small amplitude higher harmonic. We therefore assume that our sample electronic ballast luminaire does have power factor correction, in that it draws its power over the whole mains cycle rather than just at the peaks of the waveform. We do not have any easy way of measuring the distortion caused by a single electronic ballast. Queensland electrical licensing regulations are full of legalese I have read some readers comments in the Mailbag pages about electrical licensing in Queensland and thought that you might be interested in my experience. My licence was due for renewal in February and I have decided not to bother. I am supposed to do a test based on rules which I refuse to have any thing to do with, on principle. The skills maintenance course has nothing to do with electrical skills; it is to promote a rules-based profession. The documents that you have to read to do the test are called: Electrical Safety Regulation 2002, Electrical Safety Act 2002, Code Of Practice Working Near Live Parts, and Code Of Practice Electrical Work. Now if these documents were written for the general public who wanted to do thir own electrical work then it would be fine but not for people who are supposed to be highly trained. Standards and wiring rules etc have been around for a long time but these were written by electrical engineers and I would recommend them to anyone who wants to do electrical work. These new ones I believe are written by lawyers and by the many changes and revisions made to them since 2002, when they were first printed, it seems to me that they make these rules as they go along. As an example, on page 31 of the code of practice it says: “work” on an electric motor means work on the electric motor that would be electric work if the electric motor were electrical equipment”. The part that really disgusts me though are all the penalty points. All the Government departments that I have contacted, to bring this 600 pages of useless information to their attention, seem to have missed the point. I am sure that they can’t bring themselves to believe that there are laws that are fixed for all time, that don’t have to be tested in court and were not created by them. Real tradesmen only use electrical laws such as Ohm’s law. If you have a complete understanding of these laws and how to apply them, it enables you to carry out electrical work properly and safely and neatly; in other words, in a tradesman-like manner. To do all this you have to be properly trained and I believe that is why the government has resorted to the threats of heavy fines and even jail to try to force so called “electrical workers” to do their job correctly. I can remember doing some electrical work that was not as straightforward as one might think and which took a bit of mathematics. When I had finished, I asked the apprentice training with me if he could tell me why we had to do what we did. Straight away he quoted some rule numbers which may have been correct for all I know but siliconchip.com.au when I asked what electrical laws were involved he had no idea. I should have known something was wrong then. If we do go in for nuclear power stations, then I hope that they don’t use these electrical workers to wire them up! Ron Groves, Cooloola Cove, Qld. Free organ to a good home I have an Electone electronic organ to give away. It works but the key system needs some maintenance. It is large and heavy and will need a ute or truck and two people to move it. Please phone 0402 061 576 for further details. Bryan Maher, Springfield, NSW. DAB+ to FM/AM converter could be desirable I think that you were a bit hasty in dismissing the suggestion from PM, Karabar, NSW (Ask SILICON CHIP, July 2010) for a DAB+ to FM/AM converter. Keep that VCR in use With the impending demise of analog TV, there must be many people who, like me, are not fussed about High Definition and have perfectly good CRT TVs with SD STBs. I also have a nearly-new VCR with an analog tuner which will become useless. Here is a suggestion. Don’t spend $500 on a new video recorder. Obtain a second digital STB. SD boxes are available cheaply on eBay and will become even cheaper as people move to HD. Connect the composite video output to the VCR’s AV input. Now you can watch one channel It is true that FM quality at its best can be superior to digital broadcasts in terms of detail and resolution. But this comparison is only valid where a high strength FM signal can be received. At my own home I can only receive a small number of FM stations, with weak signals that are prone to fading, giving noisy audio which often drops while recording another and also time-record. The only thing you cannot do is switch channels in the same recording session; a small price to pay, I think. Note also that the antenna connection to the TV and the VCR can now be removed. This will cut down on cables and amplifiers in the circuit. Graham Hunt, Mt. Martha, Vic. Comment: good suggestion Graham, although for only a little extra money you can get the same advantage with an HDTV STB (around $80) and then you can also record programs broadcast on the HD stations. back into mono. This is despite having a roof-mounted FM aerial and a stateof-the-art analog FM tuner. This all changed recently when I was given an iRiver B30 portable media player as a birthday present. This superb little device is the same size as an iPhone, yet boasts something which the iPhone cannot match – a built Custom Battery Packs, Power Electronics & Chargers For more information, contact Phone (08) 9302 5444 or email mark<at>siomar.com www.batter ybook.com siliconchip.com.au August 2010  7 Mailbag: continued Should battery-operated devices have a Star energy rating? is far more pleasing to the ear than deathly silence. I feel sorry for the AM listeners who have gone digital with the promise of better clarity and performance. None of the portable units offer AM, so if they are listening to 2CH or 2SM, they’ve got nowhere to go when it mutes. In December 2009, Alan Hughes from WA commented on what I had to say, questioned DAB+ for their choice of Martin Place to showcase the new product and suggested I go to a local electrical retailer, as I should not have the same problems as I experienced in Martin Place. I don’t want this to become a tit for tat but that’s fine if you want the radio for home, which means the radio is stationary. As a bus driver, my radio listening pleasure is on the move and it is extremely annoying when you are stopped at the intersection of Elizabeth and Park streets in the in DAB+ receiver. The audio output from this is of very high quality and it makes a truly great front-end for my NAD amplifier and Acoustic Research speakers. The B30 tuned in a total of 43 digital stations within one minute of being first switched on and reception on all of these is perfect. This is an impressive feat when you consider this is all achieved using a tiny 6-inch telescopic antenna! Quite a few of the stations which I now listen to regularly on the B30 are only available on digital and not on FM. Your statement in your reply that “most DAB+ programs . . . can be received perfectly well . . . on standard AM/FM radios” is not really true and I am sure that many readers who like me have less than perfect FM reception would be interested in a DAB+ to AM/ FM converter. Those readers who enjoy the vintage radio section in each month’s issue are another potential user group. With older valve sets which are restricted to AM reception, the converter would allow access to both digitally broad- cast FM programs and digital-only programs, as well as extending the “listening life” of these sets beyond the time at which analog disappears. Yes, some of the frequency response would be lost due to AM reception but the point in this case is to enjoy the program material via a classic “valve sound” on a genuine old radio set. Keith Cusson, Mount Dandenong, Vic. Comment: we will reconsider the project concept. In the meantime, we have had a high quality DAB+/FM tuner under development for some time. We hope to publish the first article for this project in the September issue of SILICON CHIP. In the Mailbag pages of the October 2009 issue, I wrote to you questioning DAB+. Then in May 2010, I bit the bullet and replaced the FM radio on my bus with a Kaiser Baas Digital radio, mainly because of the new commercial-free stations ZOO and WSFM plus. All I can say is I have wasted my money. A number of my bus driver colleagues have also gone digital (purchasing Kaiser Baas, Pure and Roberts radios) and they are also questioning the benefits of digital other than the new stations on offer. When I wrote in, I said I had problems with FM around Clovelly, Bronte and Maroubra Beaches. As far as digital goes, these areas are “digital-deaf” zones. I count myself lucky as I generally listen to WS FM so when in these areas, I flick off DAB back to FM. I get some static over the audio but it 8  Silicon Chip Handy tip on USB Electrocardiograph In the Ask SILICON CHIP pages of the June 2010 issue, J. D. wrote about the USB-ECG project, regarding the sourcing of a capacitor. When testing the device, I suggest they use a “Lead 2” configuration, ie, Electrode 1 to left leg, Electrode 2 to the right arm. The other lead groups Sydney CBD with perfect reception only to totally lose it when a truck or another bus pulls up beside you at the traffic lights. This happens in so many locations. To paraphrase Alan “DAB+ is either perfect or nonexistent”. And that’s exactly what is happening in reality. Another gripe with the new digital radios is how “energy inefficient” they are. My colleagues all say they now have to recharge batteries, as do I, every two days. Our old dial radios would go for weeks before recharging was required. My radio is on for around 8-9 hours a day and I am using the same four 2700mA NiMH batteries that were in my old radio. I measured the current drain with a comfortable listening level and in the old radio it was around 40mA, while the new radio draws a huge 160mA. With the 20hr rate of my batteries being 135mA, it’s no wonder I am only managing to get two working days out of them. Simon Kareh, Penshurst, NSW. can typically give very small amplitudes; Lead 2 often shows a clearer wave form. Hope this is of help. Dr Michael Jensen. Sippy Downs, Qld. New site for DDS VFO software The DDS VFO design of mine was published in SILICON CHIP in March 2008. Due to the demise of Geocities and their hosted websites, the information on where readers can obtain downloads of the DDS VFO software and updates mentioned in that article is no longer valid. I have a new website now where this information can be downloaded, as well as other details for using the DDS VFO with different IF offsets etc at www.zl2pd.com Andrew Woodfield, ZL2PD, Christchurch, New Zealand. Accusations of Photoshop manipulation The pictures of Sanctuary Cove in the July 2010 issue really mystified me. Both pictures show enclosed pontoon siliconchip.com.au bays full of boats, a fine achievement especially if the small problem of opening and closing the “closure” to allow the ingress and egress of the boats within the closure has been solved. I was so impressed I couldn’t resist the urge to go direct to Google Earth to see a closer view for myself. Where were those opening gates to the bays? How did they achieve Solutions it? Conformal Coatings Hakko Soldering What a shock. Sanctuary Cove looks totally different on Google Earth. It just looks like a marina should with traditional bays allowing the boats access everywhere. Some big changes had somehow occurred within the computers of SILICON CHIP. So after a lifetime of seeing/reading/enjoying a really professional magazine, I now suspect someone has white-anted this fine establishment with a little too much Photoshop. It may have escaped your notice but making a glaring error like this in a top technical magazine we all highly regard is childish. It is probably a youngster in the system who doesn’t understand. Integrity is more important than a cheap shot like filling a Marina up with more boats and bays than it could ever hold. As you have named the company, its location and shown it on your cover and on page 11 in a grossly altered form, it would not be unfair of Sanctuary Cove to ask you for an apology. The original picture of the marina is fine, so why was it even considered for alteration? Bruce Wilson, Warriewood, NSW. Comment: we deny your accusations. Why would we take the trouble to extensively modify the photos? They were taken by helicopter during the show and were supplied by Kevin Poulter. We asked him to comment and here is his response: “Wish he’d go to a boat show instead of sending a detailed salvo with no basis whatsoever! The aerial photos of the Sanctuary Cove Boat Show are not modified in any way, proving that the major boat shows around Australia are an incredible logistical effort. The existing jetties are extensively supplemented by a great number of temporary ones, most being the floating type to give full public access. I also understand that many of the permanent boats Contact Lubricants PC Board Cleaning moored there are moved for the duration of the show. It’s probably the biggest boat show in the Southern Hemisphere. During that time, the huge density of boats has no resemblance to Google Earth photos, which can be years old. If Bruce is impressed how a marina can be converted for a show just for a few days, he would be gob-smacked at the size of the temporary electronics and accessories tent halls”. Kevin Poulter, SC Dingley, Vic. Maintenance & Service Aids Cleaning Resins Invertible air duster Fast drying solvent cleaner Polyurethane and epoxy 2 part resins for encapsulating electronics. Inert, pure compressed gas for dust removal Ideal for removing particulates from inaccessible areas on delicate equipment Non-flammable Available in standard and invertible versions For quick efficient removal of flux residues after soldering. Leaves a perfectly clean, dry surface Available in aerosol versions with or without brush applicator Protects PCB's from chemicals, harsh environments, water ingress & humidity. Security and concealment (industrial espionage) Cable joining Available in handy resin packs or bulk 3/98 Old Pittwater Rd, Brookvale NSW 2100 Tel (02) 9938 1566 www.electrolube.com.au siliconchip.com.au August 2010  9 Solar Power – It is often said that solar power plants can’t ‘do baseload’ – that they only provide power when the sun shines. Not so: Richard Keech and Matthew Wright* explain how solar thermal plants work and how the Spanish now get solar power around the clock using advances in thermal storage. T he talk about climate change has seen a renewed interest in power. After all, electricity generation is the largest single man-made source of greenhouse gas emissions, mostly from the burning of fossil fuels, usually coal or gas. But sustainable alternatives exist – one of the most exciting is Concentrating Solar Thermal (CST) power [sometimes called Concentrating Solar Power (CSP)]. Traditionally, solar electricity generation has been only when the sun shines. Hence the great appeal of new CST plants which can store their heat and generate power even at night. Solar resource At ground level, the power of the Sun on a one meter square surface, at right angles to the Sun’s rays is about 1kW. Excluding cloud effects, this gives an average of about 6kWh/day for every square meter in sunlight. If you do the numbers this represents a phenomenally large resource. Australia’s total current electrical peak generation capacity (about 49GW) is equivalent to what falls as sunlight on an area of about 8km x 8km (at noon at Southern Australian latitudes) or about 0.001% of the Australian landmass. When you take into account typical sunlight patterns, typical plant efficiency and layout, you would still need less than 0.05% of Australia’s land area to generate equivalent power. To put the required land area in perspective, it would fit six times into Anna Creek, Australia’s largest cattle station. It is clear that in a country like Australia, the solar resource greatly exceeds our energy needs. CST technologies Before considering how solar plants can run at night, let’s review the underlying technology of CST. They have in common the basic principle * Executive Director, Beyond Zero Emissions 10  Silicon Chip siliconchip.com.au – 24/7 of capturing solar energy to heat water to generate steam (see box below‘not all steamed up’). This steam powers a turbine, which in turn spins an electric generator to create AC power. From the point at which the steam is generated, a CST plant is similar to coal, gas or nuclear in its operating principle. A solar plant is distinguished by how that steam is generated in the first place. To capture solar energy, mirrors reflect the sun’s rays to a central collection point. Different arrangements of mirrors exist. Broadly speaking these are: troughs, power towers, linear fresnel and dishes. Trough technology In a trough configuration, long lines of mirrors with a parabolic cross section focus solar radiation on a pipe. A fluid pumped through the pipe to pick up the solar energy is heated to around 400°C. The fluid is usually a high-grade synthetic oil which does not boil or degrade at high temperatures. These oils are only suitable up to about 400°C. Trough mirro rs from a Span solar power plant (BZE ph ish oto). Trough technology is the most proven CST design. The largest solar generation facility in the world, SEGS (a set of nine plants near Kramer Junction in the Mojave desert California), uses troughs. Jointly they have a capacity of 354MW. In a trough plant, the mirrors rotate around their long (North-South) axis to track the Sun during the day. Because they remain horizontal and so don’t track the Sun’s elevation, trough mirrors are most effective close to the equator. At the latitudes of Southern Australia, trough mirrors are only about half as effective as a mirror that can track the sun. This is due to the projection effect (see ‘capturing the sun efficiently’). Linear Fresnel The curved mirror structures of a trough plant are very expensive. A less-expensive variant on the trough mirror configuration is a Linear Fresnel (pronounced ‘frenell’). These systems use long, near-flat mirrors close to the ground to make an optical approximation of a parabolic trough, without the structural complexity. Not all steame d up The main tech nology used in is steam turb present-day el ines. However ec it’s worth notin trical generation power plants are being built g that some solar which don’t us Some are us e steam. in Stirling heat en g concentrating photovol taic and som gines. Neither e use of these techno able to provid e effective en logies are curr ergy storage. ently siliconchip.com.au August ugust 2010  11 can be more efficient and cheaper than that from a trough configuration which heats to about 400°C. The turbines required in conjunction with a tower are the same as those used in coal-fired plants, whereas the turbine technology required for lowertemperature operation is considerably more expensive because of the much lower economies of scale. Heat Storage A Linear Fresnel assembly (from Areva Solar – formerly Ausra. (http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/File:Fresnel_reflectors_ausra.jpg) The systems from Biotec Novasol (owned by Australian company Transfield) and Areva Solar (formerly Australian company Ausra) both have relatively low operating temperatures (of around 290°C) and therefore there is no viable commercially available storage method. Linear Fresnel companies are moving to higher temperatures and pressures. Mann Ferrestel/Solar Power Group are offering 450°C in a Linear Fresnel configuration. Dish technology Mirrors in a dish configuration are effective at concentrating the sun and track the sun in two axes. Previously they’ve been expensive and not often used in production solar energy plants. Australia’s first solar thermal power plant was a dish-based facility at White Cliffs in NSW which operated from 1981 to 1996. This was a 25kW plant for an off-grid community and was developed by the ANU. The ANU has also developed the world’s biggest mass production solar dish system. The ANU SG4, a fourthgeneration dish is now ready for mass production. Their innovative manufacturing system involves a ‘factory in the field’. It is built in the field on a very accurate jig, instead of adjusting the dish after it has been manufactured. field of near-flat, independently controlled mirrors called heliostats to focus sunlight on a central receiver at the top of a tower. Tower configurations can scale up to configurations involving many hundreds or even thousands of mirrors. This gives towers the greatest capacity to concentrate the sun’s rays, leading to higher operating temperatures. Heliostats are spaced to ensure they don’t overshadow each other. A modern tower-based solar plant would typically pass a fluid through the receiver to be heated up to about 570°C (and in future up to about 650°C). At this temperature, electrical generation In November 2008 the 50MW Andasol 1 CST plant near Granada in southern Spain started feeding power to the grid. What was most interesting about this plant was its ability to supply power to the grid around the clock using a system of heat storage in tanks of molten salt. The adjacent Andasol 2 plant has since come online and doubled the capacity to 100MW. Andasol 3 is under construction now, with Andasol 4 in planning. These CST plants are each rated as having 7.5 hours of thermal storage. This number represents the storage when running at the full rated output of the plant. Operators can choose to run at lower output for longer periods, giving the plant round-the-clock generating potential. Molten salt The use of molten salt as a storage medium has been proven for some time (the French had a prototype test plant in the early 1980s). The US Department of Energy had a commercial Tower systems Tower-based systems use a large 12  Silicon Chip An SG4 dish mirror from ANU in Canberra (BZE photo) siliconchip.com.au Capturing the sun efficiently Heliostat mirrors track the sun in two axes which makes them more efficient than horizontal trough mirrors, especially in winter and when sited further from the equator. Compared with a dish, which gives the best sun tracking, a trough mirror captures about 75% less energy in winter at temperate latitudes because of the low angle of the sun. This reduction of collection capacity is called the projection effect. Solar engineers use the term insolation to describe the measurement of received solar energy, and Direct Normal Incidence (DNI) to describe the solar energy available to collectors which track the sun, ie, no projection effect. For horizontally-configured mirrors the insolation is less (due to the projection effect) and measured as Global Horizontal Irradiance (GHI). DNI and GHI are often confused and this confusion can cause illinformed assessments suggesting low performance for solar thermal The projection effect comparing vertical sun’s rays with rays at 30°. systems, when in fact with systems that use direct beam radiation without significant projection effect (dish and tower) perform very well in the right climatic zones all year round even at higher latitudes. The PS10 power tower near Seville in Spain (BZE picture) demonstration plant called Solar Two operating with storage in the 1990s. The salt mixture generally used is 40% Potassium Nitrate and 60% Sodium Nitrate. The salt, which is chemically very close to fertilizer, has a number of properties that make it suitable: • It is stable as a liquid over a large temperature range • It is reasonably priced • It is non-corrosive • It can be used in unpressurised, insulated carbon steel vessels. In operation, salt is pumped between two large tanks – one hot and the other (notionally) cold. The salt mixture has a freezing point of about 225°C (depending on formulation) and needs to be kept in liquid form at all times. So the ‘cold’ tank is operated at about 285°C, while the hot tank can hold a temperature of 400°C or higher. There is no material phase change involved in the use of the salt. Andasol is a trough plant. When its mirrors are collecting sunlight, it heats a synthetic oil. In turn this is passed siliconchip.com.au through a heat exchanger to re-heat the ‘cold’ salt which is pumped back into the hot tank. When electrical generation is required, the liquid salt is pumped through a steam generator to drive a conventional Rankine-cycle steam turbine and then into the ‘cold’ tank. Andasol uses Siemens SST-700 turbines, which are widely used in the power industry (www.energy.siemens. com/hq/en/power-generation/steamturbines/sst-700.htm). Power towers and storage Since Andasol was commissioned, attention is on the Gemasolar (pronounced ‘hemasolar’) Solar Tres project near Seville in Southern Spain. Solar Tres, currently under con- Molten salt tanks at Andasol (picture: BZE) August 2010  13 of cloud, it will be necessary to have some form of backup energy source. Future solar plants could, for example, utilise a renewable, low-value biofuel. Once backup is incorporated, a solar plant could provide the year-round dependability required to underpin a modern energy economy. Backup is of most benefit when a plant is installed on an isolated grid. However, on larger grids and grids integrated with wind power, zero or very minimal co-firing with biomass, storage hydro or pumped storage hydro would be required. Solar Thermal in the US The rotor of a Siemens SST-700 turbine (Photo: Siemens). struction, is a power tower rated at 17MW with 15 hours storage. When commissioned it will be the first commercial power tower with storage and will take advantage of the higher operating efficiencies possible using this configuration. The salt will be heated to about 565°C. At these temperatures, each MWh of energy generated requires about 25 tonnes of salt. Plants operating at lower temperatures require proportionally more salt per unit of energy stored; with an upper temperature of 400°C, the energy stored is about 1MWh per 75 tonnes of salt. Changing the relative sizing of the mirrors, storage and turbine allows for different balance between maximum power and energy storage. In the case of Solar Tres, with 15 hours of storage at full power, gives true baseload capacity. The trade off between power and storage is shown below. These levels of average utilisation (about 75%) compare favourably with Australian baseload coal-fired power plants. On average NSW coal plants operate at an average 63% of rated capacity. Bad weather backup To deal with the inevitable periods Spain has taken the early lead with the first commercial CST-with-storage plants. However in the USA, the Bureau of Land Management (BLM) has received over 100,000MW of plant approval applications on BLM land in six states alone. Half of all these applications are for tower-type systems with much of those using molten salt as a working fluid and 24-hour dispatch storage media. This year, according to the head of the SEIA, Fred Morse and head of Sandia National Laboratories, Thomas Mancini, it is expected that around 11 large scale solar thermal plants will be started. Each of these projects will take less than two years to build. Contrast this with 12-24 months for wind plants, 5-7 years for coal plants and 7.5-19 years for nuclear plants. Costs Currently first-of-a-kind, mediumscale solar plants with storage are being built in the US which can generate power at about 20 cents per kWh. New technologies always follow a cost-reduction curve once they mature and economies of scale are realised. Research suggests that when the installed capacity expands by a further 8700MW, CST plants could reach cost parity with new coal and gas plants, providing power at around 5c per kWh. Re-powering Australia Trading of power and storage (source: BZE Solar Flagships). 14  Silicon Chip Australia’s entire energy needs could conceivably be met with a 60:40 mix of Spanish-style solar thermal and wind. Other technologies, such as geothermal and wave power, show promise siliconchip.com.au ANTRIM TRANSFORMERS manufactured in Australia by Harbuch Electronics Pty Ltd harbuch<at>optusnet.com.au Toroidal – Conventional Transformers Power – Audio – Valve – ‘Specials’ Medical – Isolated – Stepup/down Encased Power Supplies Toroidal General Construction OUTER INSULATION OUTER WINDING WINDING INSULATION INNER WINDING CORE CORE INSULATION Comprehensive data available: www.harbuch.com.au Harbuch Electronics Pty Ltd 9/40 Leighton Pl, HORNSBY 2077 Ph (02) 9476 5854 Fax (02) 9476 3231 The Gemasolar Solar Tres plant under construction in February 2010 (photo: Torresol Energy). but solar thermal and wind can be deployed at scale today and could be sufficient to entirely power the Australian electricity grid. This research has been done as part of the Zero Carbon Australia 2020 plan at www.zerocarbonplan.org Conclusion The Spanish are really onto something. Using technology pioneered by the French and Americans, they have demolished the myth that you can’t do baseload power with renewable energy. siliconchip.com.au There are now two companies, Torresol from Spain and Solar Reserve from the USA, with commercially available solar power system with storage. These systems’ operating characteristics compare well with conventional coal, nuclear or gas combined cycle plant. We no longer have to wait for years of research to bear fruit and we no longer have any excuse to delay. The future of renewable energy seems bright indeed. SC August 2010  15 For those who thought flat-screen TV was a recent innovation, check out this article from Electronics Australia (sorry, reproduction wasn’t quite as good then!). And now look at the date: 42 years ago this month . . . and it was all done with 78,000 tungsten pilot globes! 16  Silicon Chip siliconchip.com.au The snippet on the right side of this page also makes very interesting reading: they were talking about the fore-runner to one of the most popular TV tubes ever made – Sony’s mighty Trinitron (not TRI-nitron as some used to call it!). siliconchip.com.au August 2010  17 SILICON CHIP If you are seeing a blank page here, it is more than likely that it contained advertising which is now out of date and the advertiser has requested that the page be removed to prevent misunderstandings. Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website: dicksmith.com.au SILICON CHIP If you are seeing a blank page here, it is more than likely that it contained advertising which is now out of date and the advertiser has requested that the page be removed to prevent misunderstandings. Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website: dicksmith.com.au QUAD hifi gear: how it stacks up 30 years on Quad introduced the world’s first full-range electrostatic speakers in 1957. Our photo shows two ESL63 second generation units from the early 1980s, together with a Quad CD player, FM tuner, stereo preamplifier and 100W/channel stereo power amplifier. Thirty years ago, any hifi enthusiast worthy of the name would have hocked his soul for a Quad hifi system with electrostatic loudspeakers. But how does the Quad gear of that era stack up against modern hifi gear? Q UAD WAS A NAME revered by those who were into hifi sound during the 1950s, ’60s, ’70s and ’80s. Founded in the UK in 1936, they made a name for themselves building highquality power amplifiers, speakers and other audio gear. They introduced the world’s first full-range electrostatic speakers in 1957. So when our very own Serviceman told us he had inherited a Quad elec20  Silicon Chip trostatic system from a relative in the UK and asked if would we like to listen to it, we jumped at the opportunity. At the forefront of our minds was the question: how would the legendary Quad system compare to the best audio equipment available today? Did it deserve its reputation? Line-up and appearance The system consists of seven com- ponents: two Quad ESL63 electrostatic loudspeakers, one Quad “L-ite” subwoofer, the amplifier/preamplifier/FM tuner group and a Quad 66 CD player (a relatively recent addition). The ESL63s are second-generation electrostatic speakers introduced in 1981. Their appearance is consistent with that era – whether that is a good or bad thing depends heavily on taste. The subwoofer has a more modern, polished metal appearance with a LED display at the front. The amplifier/preamplifier/FM tuner group is made of three distinct units stacked in a small wooden cabinet, which is painted dark grey to match them. Individually they are the Quad FM4 tuner, Quad 44 preamplifier and Quad 405-2 100W Stereo Current siliconchip.com.au 05/13/10 07:40:55 Quad Pre+Amp Frequency Response (4 ) +10 +8 +6 By NICHOLAS VINEN Output Level (dBr) +4 +2 -0 -2 -4 -6 -8 -10 10 20 50 100 200 500 1k 2k 5k 10k 20k 50k 100k Frequency (Hz) Fig.1: the frequency response of the Quad 405-2 amplifier. The -3dB points are 15Hz and 35kHz, which is within its specifications but not as flat as many modern amplifiers. 5 Quad 405-2 THD+N vs Power (8Ω) 05/12/10 14:34:01 2 1 THD+N (%) 0.5 0.2 0.1 0.05 0.02 0.01 50m 100m 200m 500m 1 2 5 10 20 50 100 Power (Watts) Dumping Amplifier. Interestingly, the amplifier pre-dates the ESL63 speakers – it was released in 1975 and was regarded as a landmark unit at the time. Their front panels feature nicely machined metal switches, pushbuttons and knobs. Because all mains power passes through it, turning on the preamplifier also turns on the other components. It has five stereo inputs, a volume knob with 22 detents, a bass lift filter, a “tilt” filter (which cuts treble while it boosts bass and vice versa) and an adjustable low-pass filter. There is also a balance control and a stereo/mono switch. The FM tuner is rather simple, with seven station preset buttons and a manual “tune” button. Tuning is accomplished with a knob and the nearest frequency (to within 50kHz) is shown on a digital display. The power amplifier has no front panel as such, instead sporting a substantial black, finned heatsink across the full width. The Quad CD player is similarly spartan, with just a power switch, eject button and display. The other controls siliconchip.com.au Fig.2: THD+N vs Power for the Quad 405-2 amplifier at 1kHz/8Ω, measured with a 20Hz-22kHz bandwidth. Its distortion at low powers is relatively high due to noise. are on the remote. Similarly, the subwoofer controls are handled entirely by the infrared remote. Electrostatic speakers Before we begin discussing the performance, it is worth explaining how these speakers work. Modern “dynamic” loudspeakers use a voice coil/cone assembly and a rear-mounted permanent magnet. If an audio signal is fed to the voice coil, it interacts with the magnetic field produced by the magnet and the cone moves back and forth as a result to generate the sound waves. By contrast, electrostatic loudspeakers use an electric field rather than a magnetic field. Each driver consists of a metallised plastic panel suspended between perforated sheet metal grids at the front and rear. This conductive sheet is charged up to a high voltage (in this case, 5.25kV). August 2010  21 Quad 405-2 THD+N vs Power (4Ω) 05/12/10 14:32:27 5 2 2 1 1 0.5 0.5 THD+N (%) THD+N (%) 5 0.2 0.1 0.05 0.05 0.02 0.02 200m 500m 1 2 5 10 20 50 0.01 50m 100m 100 200m 500m 1 2 5 10 20 50 100 Power (Watts) Power (Watts) Fig.3: THD+N vs Power for the Quad 405-2 amplifier at 1kHz but with a 4Ω load. More power is available but noise and harmonic distortion levels are higher. It is generated from the mains voltage so each electrostatic speaker needs a mains power connection (via an IEC socket on the base stand). The audio signal from the amplifier is stepped up by a transformer which drives both grids. As a result, the very thin metallised sheet is moved by the electric field in a push-pull manner, generating the sound waves. To get good performance across the audio spectrum, it is necessary to break the panel up into multiple zones of different shapes and sizes which 5 05/12/10 15:08:08 0.2 0.1 0.01 50m 100m Quad Pre+Amp THD+N vs Power (4Ω) Fig.4: the same measurement as Fig.3 but with the Quad 44 preamplifier in circuit. It adds a lot of noise, increases the distortion level and reduces channel tracking, since there is no way to disable the balance control. are electrically independent (aside from the common high-voltage bias). Smaller sections reproduce treble and larger sections bass. A crossover filter network distributes the audio signal appropriately. Each ESL63 has eight of these zones. One typical problem with electrostatic speakers is that, due to the transformer-coupled input, the DC resistance across the input terminals can be quite low which means that a special amplifier is required. However, the ESL63’s input has just under 4Ω DC Quad Pre+Amp THD+N vs Frequency (4Ω) 05/12/10 15:10:30 resistance so a standard 100W amplifier can be used (provided it is stable with transformer loads). Subjective impressions Before we hooked the gear up to our test equipment we thought we would have a listen. Since all the gear had been sent to the Quad factory in the UK for a check-up before being despatched to Australia we expected that it would all be performing up to scratch. So how did it sound? Hmm, to be Quad FM4 Tuner Quieting Performance +10 0 2 -10 Signal-to-Noise Ratio (dB) 1 THD+N (%) 0.5 0.2 0.1 -20 -30 -40 -50 -60 0.05 -70 0.02 -80 0.01 20 50 100 200 500 1k 2k 5k 10k Frequency (Hz) Fig.5: this graph shows THD+N vs frequency for the amplifier and pre­amplifier combination at 5W output into 4Ω. The distortion is above 0.04% across much of the frequency range. 22  Silicon Chip 2 10 20k Mono Noise Mono Signal 100 Signal Level (µV) Stereo Noise Stereo Signal 1k 10k 20k Signal Strength Indicator Fig.6: this graph shows how the tuner’s signal-to-noise ratio is affected by RF signal strength. The ultimate signalto-noise ratio is -75dB for mono and -72dB for stereo. siliconchip.com.au honest we were not overly excited. It was OK. In more detail, our impression was that the treble was distinctly muted and certainly lacked the “sheen” of a system with a top-end ribbon or dome tweeter with ferrofluid cooling. Nor was the bass particularly notable, with the lowest octave from a piano, pipe organ, double-bass or harp just not there. The midrange was good; very smooth and without any tendency to emphasise voice or brass instruments. On the other hand, sibilants were muted, as were cymbals, snare drums and so on. The sound lacked zing. To paraphrase that old Duke Ellington classic, “It don’t mean a thing, if it ain’t got that zing”. Furthermore, stereo imaging is diffuse due to the large radiating surfaces. You cannot pinpoint voices or instruments across a “stereo stage” as you can with a stereo system with conventional tweeters which are effectively point sources. Initially, we listened to the system without the subwoofer but noting that low bass was missing, we connected it up and listened again. It gave a big improvement to the bass response, although the subwoofer needs careful adjustment to avoid giving exaggerated bass. In fact, we have always felt this way about subwoofers, unless they are very carefully set up so that the upper bass and low bass levels are correct. Measurements Overall, we were disappointed with our first listening session. So what was letting the side down? Was it the muchvaunted ESL-63 electrostatics, the famous Quad 405 “current dumping” amplifier, the Quad 44 preamplifier or the Quad CD player? Or all of the above? It is difficult to measure the performance of the speakers themselves since we don’t have a set-up with calibrated microphone and software but we made extensive measurements of the amplifier, preamplifier, tuner and CD player with our Audio Precision distortion analyser. This revealed that, compared with the best hifi equipment available today, the Quad gear is fairly average. Sorry Mr Quad but this is the truth. Let’s look at the Quad 405 first. It has a reasonably flat frequency response which is -1dB at 20Hz and 20kHz (see Fig.1). Furthermore, its THD+N siliconchip.com.au Unlike the Japanese gear of the era, Quad hifi equipment was disarmingly simple in appearance. This photo shows Quad’s 66 CD player (top), FM4 tuner, 44 stereo preamplifier and 405-2 stereo power amplifier (bottom). (total harmonic distortion + noise) is around 0.01% for 8Ω loads and 0.02% for 4Ω loads (see Figs.2 & 3). Again, this is good but hardly world-beating. The relative flatness of the distortion curve indicates that the distortion is mostly harmonic, rather than the result of noise. It also has a below average damping factor of 45 at 4Ω and 88 at 8Ω, although that isn’t low enough to cause any serious degradation of the frequency response. So why are we so cool on the Quad 405? Take a look at Table 1. It compares THD+N measurements of the Quad 405-2 to a progression of SILICON CHIP designs. As you can see, our Ultra-LD designs from the last 10 years or so are at least an order of magnitude better (ie, more than 10 times better). That’s a big difference. Oh, and that’s without considering our 20W Class-A design which is in a class of its own. When the Quad 44 preamplifier performance is coupled to the amplifier it adds significant distortion, as can be seen in Fig.4. In fact, there is so much noise from the preamp that the THD+N measurement at 50mW is doubled. It also adds a moderate amount of additional harmonic distortion, bringing the minimum level up to 0.015% for 8Ω loads. So even though the Quad 405 “current dumping” amplifier was a very significant design when it was first introduced in the late 1970s, it has been well and truly left behind. FM tuner By contrast, the Quad FM tuner performs well by modern standards. Its frequency response is ±1dB from 20Hz to 15kHz in both mono and stereo. THD+N is 0.09% for mono signals and 0.15% for stereo at 1kHz. Fig.6 shows the quieting curves along with the signal strength indicator bar reading (which is a 10 dot dual bargraph). Ultimate signal-to-noise ratio is above 70dB for mono and stereo Table 1: Power Amplifier Performance Comparison Amplifier THD+N <at> 1kHz 8Ω THD+N <at> 20kHz 8Ω Quad 405-2 0.01% 0.02% Studio 200 (February 1988) <0.01% Not stated Plastic Power (April 1996) 0.0025% 0.01% Ultra-LD (May 2000) 0.0015% 0.004% SC-480 (January 2003) 0.003% 0.02% Ultra-LD Mk.2 (August 2008) 0.0008% 0.0045% August 2010  23 Frequency response is flat at -0.01dB and +0.05dB over 20Hz-20kHz; also pretty good. Test reactions Quad’s ESL63 electrostatic loudspeakers. Each driver consists of a metallised plastic panel suspended between perforated sheet metal grids at the front and rear. The plastic panel is charged to 5.25kV and the audio signal is stepped up by a transformer and applied to the grids. signals which is quite good. Interestingly, while the FM tuner does have a digital frequency readout, it is not a synthesised design and it is tuned in the old-fashioned way by a tuning gang and knob, rather than in precise 50kHz steps denominated by a microprocessor. It is also quite difficult to tune precisely on station, necessary to get the best performance. That is one reason why frequency-synthesised designs took over. CD player The Quad 66 CD player is a reasonable performer by modern standards, although it has a surprisingly sharp rise in distortion above 12kHz. Compared to a 15-year old run-of-the-mill Sony CDP-XE300, the Quad 66 has lower distortion between 5kHz and 12kHz but somewhat higher distortion outside this range (see Table 3). It has a digital output so it could be connected to an external DAC (such as the SILICON CHIP DAC, September-November 2009) for lower distortion. Its signal-to-noise ratio is good at -107dB and channel separation is excellent at -106dB at 10kHz. Overall linearity is also very good, with its output at -91.9dB for a -90dB signal. Table 2: Quad FM4 Tuner Performance Mono Stereo THD+N 0.09% 0.15% Signal-To-Noise Ratio 75dB 72dB Minimum Signal Level for 3% THD+N 7µV (28dBf) 15µV (35dBf) 50dB Quieting 22µV (38dBf) 25µV (39dBf) Measurement Table 3: Quad 66 CD Player vs Sony CDP-XE300 Measurement Quad 66 CD Player Sony CDP-XE300 THD+N, 1kHz (20Hz-22kHz) 0.00487% 0.00281% THD+N, 10kHz (20Hz-80kHz) 0.00564% 0.01838% THD+N, 15kHz (20Hz-80kHz) 0.02720% 0.02222% THD+N, 20kHz (20Hz-80kHz) 0.18525% 0.01767% 24  Silicon Chip Our overall reaction to the above tests was that clearly, while the individual Quad components were decent performers at the time they were released, they have been well and truly left behind as technology has progressed. The electrostatic speakers have a certain charm with a smooth midrange but they struggle at the extremes of the audible range. Neither the Quad 4052 amplifier nor Quad 44 preamplifier have particularly low distortion or noise. A modern, good quality amplifier/preamplifier combination will outperform them. The FM tuner is fine but superior units are available from companies like Yamaha and Denon. The Quad CD player is merely average compared to most brand-name players released in the last 15 years and also the better quality DVD or BluRay players. Finally, we decided to listen to the Quad ESL-63s when driven by an Ultra-LD Stereo Amplifier (SILICON CHIP, November 2001-January 2002) and the abovementioned Sony CD player, together with the Quad subwoofer. Talk about chalk and cheese! This combination gave extended treble and much more extended bass and was much more satisfying overall, on a wide variety of music. In fact, while you might want to keep the ESL-63s, you would not now bother with the rest of the original system. No, that’s not right – you would not bother with the electrostatics either. You would opt for a decent pair of dynamic loudspeakers – even Quad make those now! Conclusion All this is not to say that the (previously) revered Quad system sounds bad. It’s still quite pleasant to listen to. We somehow needed to convey this reaction to our Serviceman. Remember that he paid a motsa to have the whole system checked over by Quad in the UK and then had it shipped out to Australia. Should we sugar-coat our reactions? In the end, we gave it to him straight, “Mate, it’s pretty ordinary”. He took it reasonably well, considSC ering. siliconchip.com.au SILICON SILIC CHIP siliconchip.com.au YOUR DETAILS 6 MONTH SUBS AND AUTO RENEWAL NOW AVAILABLE Your Name_________________________________________________________ Order Form/Tax Invoice Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd ABN 49 003 205 490 PO BOX 139, COLLAROY NSW 2097 email: silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au Phone (02) 9939 3295 Fax (02) 9939 2648 This form may be photocopied without infringing copyright. (PLEASE PRINT) Address______________________________­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­___________________­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­­___________________________________________________ Postcode__________ Daytime Phone No. ( )____________________ Email address ________________________________ Method of Payment: q EFT (ring or email for details) q Cheque/Money Order q PayPal q Visa Card q Master Card Card No.                                Card expiry date: Signature_________________________________________________ YOUR ORDER (SILICON CHIP PRINTED EDITION SUBSCRIBERS# QUALIFY FOR 10% DISCOUNT (except on subscriptions!) SIMPLY TICK THE ITEMS REQUIRED – DON'T FORGET TO FILL IN DETAILS ABOVE. WE'LL WORK THE TOTAL OUT FOR YOU AND SEND YOU A RECEIPT WITH YOUR ORDER SILICON CHIP SUBSCRIPTIONS (all prices include P&P) SILICON CHIP BOOKSHOP (P&P additional – See below) q AUSTRALIA 6 MONTHS (INC. GST) (NEW!).......................................................$49.50 q AUSTRALIA 12 MONTHS (INC. GST)..................................................................$94.50 q AUSTRALIA 12 MONTHS WITH BINDER (INC. GST) .......................................$111.00 q AUSTRALIA 24 MONTHS (INC. GST)................................................................$182.00 q AUSTRALIA 24 MONTHS WITH 2 BINDERS (INC. GST) .................................$215.00 q NEW ZEALAND 6 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) (NEW!)............................................ $AU55.00 q NEW ZEALAND 12 MONTHS (AIR MAIL)....................................................... $AU99.00 q NEW ZEALAND 24 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) ................................................... $AU196.00 q OVERSEAS (EXCEPT NZ) 6 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) (NEW!)............................. $AU75.00 q OVERSEAS (EXCEPT NZ) 12 MONTHS (AIR MAIL)...................................... $AU135.00 q OVERSEAS (EXCEPT NZ) 24 MONTHS (AIR MAIL) .................................... $AU260.00 NEW! CONVENIENT AUTOMATIC SUBSCRIPTION RENEWAL: q Tick here if you'd like us to automatically renew your subscription when it elapses q q q q q q q q q q q q q q q q q q q q q q q q q q    (ie, 6 month, 12 month or 24 month). We'll renew until you tell us to stop! BACK ISSUES/ARTICLE PHOTOCOPIES q SILICON CHIP BACK ISSUES*; SC/EA/ETI PHOTOCOPIES – includes P&P – $12.00 within Australia; $15.00 overseas *where in stock - photocopy of article supplied where issue is out of stock. EA/ETI: no back issues left, only photocopies available. Price is for each back issue or each article photocopy. Nominate issue and article required: Month:...................................... Year:......................... Article required:.................................................................................................................... Please attach list if more than one back issue or photocopy required. There is a 10% discount for ten or more back issues and/or photocopies (no further discount applies). SILICON CHIP MAGAZINE BINDERS q Embossed "SILICON CHIP", securely holds 12 months+ of issues Available in Australia only.......................................................................................$14.95 (P&P is $10.00 per order; buy five or more in one order for FREE P&P) P&P RATES: Subscriptions, back issues and project reprints: P&P included Binders (available Australia only): $10.00 per order; for 5 or more P&P is free. Books: Aust. $10 per order; NZ: $AU12 per book; Elsewhere $AU18 per book To eMAIL (24/7) Place silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au Your with order & credit card details siliconchip.com.au Order: OR FAX (24/7) This form (or a photocopy) to (02) 9939 2648 with all details AC MACHINES................................................................................................ $66.00 AMATEUR SCIENTIST CD NEW! Version 4.0................................................. $62.00 AUDIO POWER AMPLIFIER DESIGN – SELF (NEW 5th EDITION) ..............$130.00 BUILD YOUR OWN ELECTRIC MOTORCYCLE (NEW)....................................$47.95 DVD PLAYERS AND DRIVES ........................................................................ $95.00 ELECTRIC MOTORS AND DRIVES.................................................................. $60.00 ELECTRONIC PROJECTS FOR CARS (2003) – last few, shop-soiled – now... $2.95 HANDS-ON ZIGBEE ....................................................................................... $96.50 NEWNES GUIDE TO TELEVISION AND VIDEO TECHNOLOGY........................ $70.00 OP AMPS FOR EVERYONE.......................................................................... $120. 00 PERFORMANCE ELECTRONICS FOR CARS.................................................... $19.80 PIC IN PRACTICE........................................................................................... $65.00 PIC MICROCONTROLLERS - KNOW IT ALL................................................... $90.00 PIC MICROCONTROLLER - PERSONAL INTRO COURSE............................... $60.00 PRACTICAL GUIDE TO SATELLITE TV (7th edition)...................................... $49.00 PRACTICAL RF HANDBOOK .......................................................................... $90.00 PRACT. VARIABLE SPEED DRIVES/POWER ELECT...................................... $105.00 PROGRAMMING 16-BIT MICROCONTROLLERS IN C.................................... $90.00 RADIO, TV AND HOBBIES ON DVD-ROM ...................................................... $62.00 RF CIRCUIT DESIGN...................................................................................... $75.00 SELF ON AUDIO (2nd edition)........................................................................ $90.00 SOLAR SUCCESS - GETTING IT RIGHT EVERY TIME..................................... $47.50 SOLAR THAT REALLY WORKS ...................................................................... $42.50 SWITCHING POWER SUPPLIES A-Z (inc CD-ROM)..................................... $115.00 TV ACROSS AUSTRALIA ............................................................................... $49.95 USING UBUNTU LINUX.................................................................................. $27.00 #10% discount offer does not apply to online edition subscribers nor to website orders OR PAYPAL (24/7) OR Use PayPal to pay silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au *ALL ITEMS SUBJECT TO AVAILABILITY. PRICES VALID FOR MONTH OF MAGAZINE ISSUE ONLY. ALL PRICES INCLUDE GST PHONE – (9-5, Mon-Fri) Call (02) 9939 3295 with your credit card details OR MAIL This form to PO Box 139, Collaroy NSW 2097 August 2010  25 08/10 Words by Leo Simpson Design by Branko Justic* *Oatley Electronics High-power reversible DC motor speed controller Here’s a 12-32V 30A speed controller that’s easy to build. It’s available in two versions – reversible and non-reversible – and features soft start, relay switching of motor direction and PWM speed control. T HIS REVERSIBLE DC Motor Speed Controller uses a pair of highpower Mosfets connected in parallel to drive the motor and a unique relay changeover circuit to make it reversible. It can operate from 12-32V batteries at currents up to 30A. Logic control of the relay changeover circuit means that it can only change direction when the motor is stopped. The unit comes in two kit versions. The first is the basic speed control with two paralleled Mosfets and a dual op amp to provide pulse width modulation (PWM). The second version adds the relay changeover circuit 26  Silicon Chip and its logic control. If you don’t need a reversing feature, you only need buy the basic kit. Either way, the speed control can be via an onboard trimpot, via an external 5kΩ potentiometer, or via a motorcycle throttle based on a Hall Effect sensor. This could be ideal for a wheelchair controller or an electric bike. Circuit description Refer now to Fig.3 which shows both sections of the circuit. The lefthand side is the basic speed controller while on the righthand side are the relays and associated logic control. First, let’s focus on IC1 (the LM358 dual op amp) and the 5kΩ potentiometer. Op amp IC1a and its associated components comprise a triangle wave oscillator. Its frequency is around 300Hz and its output amplitude is around 1V peak-to-peak. The mean DC level of this triangle waveform can be lifted up or down, dependent on the setting of the 5kΩ speed control potentiometer. This output waveform is connected to the non-inverting input of IC1b, pin 5. IC1b is connected as a comparator and it compares the triangle waveform with the 3.5V fixed reference at its pin siliconchip.com.au Fig.1: the scope grab illustrates the basic operation. The triangle wave from the oscillator is compared to a 3.5V reference (pink trace) and when it exceeds this reference, a corresponding motor drive pulse (blue trace) is produced. 6. When the speed control is advanced so that peaks of the triangular waveform at pin 5 exceed the 3.5V reference voltage at pin 6, the output at pin 7 goes high and this turns on two power Mosfets, Q6 & Q7. This means that the Mosfets are pulsed on whenever the triangle waveform peaks go above 3.5V. Advancing the speed control increases the duty cycle of the pulses. The circuit operation is demonstrated above in the two scope screen grabs of Fig.1 & Fig.2. In each case, the green trace shows the triangle waveform while the pink trace shows the 3.5V reference which is fixed. As you can see, each time a portion of the triangle waveform intersects the pink trace and is above it, there is a corresponding pulse to the Mosfet gates, as shown by the blue trace. The voltage across the motor, between the positive supply line and Fig.2: this scope screen grab shows the operation at higher throttle settings. The triangle waveform now exceeds the reference voltage for a greater proportion of the time and so the pulses fed to the motor are much wider. the Mosfet drains, is shown in the yellow trace. Fig.1 shows the operation at a very low throttle setting and so the pulses fed to the motor are very narrow and its speed will be low. By contrast, Fig.2 shows the operation at higher throttle settings. As can be seen, the corresponding pulses fed to the motor are much wider. When the throttle control is fully advanced, this results in the triangle waveform being wholly above 3.5V. This means that pin 7 of IC1 remains high permanently and so Mosfets Q6 & Q7 are turned on continuously. Soft start When power is first applied to the controller circuit, the 100µF capacitor on pin 6 of IC1b is discharged which means that pin 6 will be high at about +7V. The capacitor then begins to charge via the 39kΩ resistors on pin 6, thus pulling the voltage at pin 6 down to 3.5V. Therefore, at the instant when the power is applied the motor cannot run, even if the throttle is fully advanced. This gives the circuit a “soft start” feature and the motor cannot start with a lurch at initial power-up. Two regulators There are two transistor regulator Where To Buy Kits Kits for this project are available from Oatley Electronics Pty Ltd, PO Box 89, Oatley, NSW 2223. Phone (02) 9584 3563. Website: oatleyelectronics.com The reversible version (Cat. K275) costs $39 plus p&p, while the basic non-reversible version is $24 plus p&p. Are all oscilloscopes created equal? "Cleverscope is still the best out there, keep up the good work !!!!!" Karl, USA Signal: Video color burst, as presented to an ADC. Task: check DC Ours: We have proper DC offset and 10, 12 or levels, noise, and Ours spectral leakage. 14 bit resolution. We digitize over the range 1.2 www.cleverscope.com siliconchip.com.au to 1.5V. With the 10 bit ADC the resolution is 0.3/1000 = 300 uV - with 14 bit ADC it’s 18uV! You see all the detail. The spectral response has good SNR. Theirs: They don’t have DC offset, and only 8 bits. They have to digitize over -2V to +2V to capture this signal. The resolution is 4000/256 = 16 mV - 52x worse than ours. You don’t see all the detail, and the spectral response has poor SNR. August 2010  27 +7V BAT+ Q2 BDX37 +7V C E A B 4.7k 1k 100nF 100 µF 100 µF E 39k Q3 BD140 HALL EFFECT THROTTLE λ LED1 K B RED C +5V K 1 E ZD1 15V 1M 2 IC1a 1 10k D 8 +3.5V 6 22Ω 7 IC1b Q6 IRF2804 G S 4 Q1 1M E A D1 1k 47nF 1M 5 C 1V P-P 4.7nF OR 5.6nF D 39k 22Ω Q7 IRF2804 G K S * USE EITHER TRIMPOT VR1 OR EXTERNAL 5k POT OR HALL EFFECT THROTTLE SC  2010 MOT– A IC1: LM358 B 100 µF 63V K 3 ZERO VR2 2k 2.2k B 47nF 220k A C A +4V TO +5V 5k POT (ALTERNATIVE TO HALL EFFECT THROTTLE) 4.7k Q5 BDX37 D7 VR1* 5k 2 D2 SR1060 (USE WIRE LINK FOR 12V OPERATION) R1 4 3 K 4.7k 3.3k GREEN BLACK 470Ω DC MOTOR SPEED CONTROL BAT– D6: 1N4004 A D1, D3-D5, D7: 1N4148 A K ZD1 A K K Fig.3: the circuit uses op amp IC1a to generate a 300Hz triangle wave. This is DC level shifted using the throttle and fed to comparator IC1b which then generates the PWM square-wave pulses to drive Mosfets Q6 & Q7 and the motor. Relays RLY1, RLY1a, RLY2 & RLY2a and their associated control circuit (IC2a-IC2d) provide the reversing feature. circuits in the controller. The first regulator, comprising transistors Q2 & Q3 and red LED1, provides the +7V rail. It works like this: LED1 provides a 1.8V reference at the base of Q3 and the resulting 1.1V at Q3’s emitter causes 2.34mA to flow in its 470Ω emitter resistor and through the 3.3kΩ resistor at its collector. This provides +7.7V at Q4’s base and so +7V appears at Q4’s emitter. This sets the voltage conditions for the throttle and the triangle wave generator based on IC1a. The second regulator is based on zener diode ZD1 and transistor Q5. ZD1 provides a 15V reference and is bypassed by a 47nF capacitor to the base of Q5 which operates as an emitter follower. Interestingly, for battery 28  Silicon Chip voltages of less than about 16V, ZD1 will not be biased on (ie, no zener current will flow) and therefore Q5 will act as a simple capacitance multiplier filter. It provides the supply rail to IC1 and thereby ensures that the gates of the Mosfets are driven with more than 10V, provided the battery voltage is at least 12V. This is desirable to ensure that the Mosfets are turned on fully to minimise their voltage loss and power dissipation. For higher battery voltages, up to 32V, ZD1 and Q5 ensure that the gate voltage delivered by IC1b is limited to about 13V. Note that the circuit shows three alternative throttle arrangements. The first is via trimpot VR1 which can be installed on the PC board. The second is for an external 5kΩ speed control and the third is a twist grip Hall Effect throttle. Only one of these options can be used at any one time. Trimpot VR2 is a zero control. This is adjusted so that no voltage is applied to the motor at the minimum setting of the speed control. Relay switching Having a speed control on a motor is all very well but in many applications you need to run the motor in forward or reverse. In order to do this on a DC motor, you need to swap the connections to the motor. In small motor circuits that could be done by a double-pole changeover switch but siliconchip.com.au +7V BAT+ +12V 100 µF 63V E RLY2,2A GREEN LINKS FOR 12V OPERATION C RLY1,1A K D6 1N4004 RED LINK FOR 24V OPERATION D A NOTE: REPLACE RELAY LINK WITH 82 Ω 2W RESISTOR FOR 32V OPERATION RELAY LINK B +7V MOT– 2.7k D3 K 47k 100 µF 5 A IC2b 100 µF 4 6 1M A D5 1M K 39k MOTOR IC2: 4093B 1 12V–32V BATTERY IC2a 3 A 9 K 12 10 IC2c D4 39k IC2d 13 2 HOLD DOWN FOR REVERSE 14 8 S1 47nF 11 7 A 2.7k LED2 47nF 2.7k λ A K λ LED3 B K BAT– LEDS K A * NOTE: CORRECT FOR D2: SR1060* THE SR1060 DIODES USED IN THIS KIT, BUT NOT THE STANDARD K SR1060 PINOUTS A when heavy currents are involved, relays are required. In the simplest arrangement, this can be done with a single large doublepole double-throw (DPDT) relay or it could be done with two single-pole double-throw (SPDT) relays being switched simultaneously. This circuit is a little novel in that uses four SPDT relays with the relays used as paralleled pairs to substantially increase the switch contact rating. But there is a further refinement in that the heavy motor currents are never actually broken by the relay contacts. Instead, the relays are only operated when the voltage across the load is zero and therefore no current is flowing. This means that there will not be siliconchip.com.au B C any contact arcing and accompanying contact erosion. Relay logic controller The relay logic controller is based on a 4093 quad 2-input Schmitt trigger NAND gate package. Gates IC2c & IC2d are connected as an RS flipflop which can be set or reset by having one of its inputs at pins 8 & 13 pulled low. Pin 10 controls the relay switching transistor Q4, so when this output is high, the relays are on and this provides the reverse direction for the motor. Pins 1 & 2 of IC2a are normally pulled high by the series-connected 1MΩ and 39kΩ resistors but when pushbutton switch S1 is pressed, the inputs are pulled low. When the motor C IRF2804 D G B E Q4 BD681 E BD140, BD681 BDX37 C8050 C E D S is running, the drains of the Mosfets (Q6 & Q7) are being pulsed low and this repeatedly pulls the negative side of the 100µF capacitor connected to pins 5 & 6 of IC2b low, via diode D3. Hence the output of IC2b is high and this pulls pins 8 & 13 high via diodes D5 & D4 respectively, so the RS flipflop cannot be toggled. Therefore motor direction cannot be changed while ever it is running. When the Mosfets are off, the motor stops running and pins 5 & 6 of IC2b are pulled high via the associated 47kΩ resistor, the 100µF capacitor being discharged. The motor direction cannot be changed during this discharge time which is around four seconds. This feature prevents sudden changes in the August 2010  29 USE ONE OR THE OTHER + – 5k POT TO BATTERY (12V– 32V) HALL EFFECT THROTTLE LINK B & C AND LINK D & E FOR 12V OPERATION LINK C & D FOR 24V OR 32V OPERATION BD140 BDX37 SPEED + Q2 LED1 Q3 2.2k 15V 470 4.7k 4.7k* * 3.3k MOT– 47k 4148 1M 39k 2.7k 2.7k 1M D5 MOT– D4 4148 39k BAT– RLY1 + Q6 BAT– FWD/REV 47nF S1 + + LED2 LED3 IC2 4093B RLY1A P4 100 F VR1* 5k Q5 BDX37 47nF REV 47nF RLY2 P3 1k 4.7nF P2 RED WIRE D7 IC1 LM358 39k 22 22 220k 39k 4.7k FWD BAT+ ZD1 K275A R1 100 F+ A SR1060 D2 K +7V BAT+ TO MOTOR +7V RLY2A P1 GREEN WIRE 100 F Q4 RELAY LINK* * * D6 100  F 4004 BD681 100 F 2.7k D B E C 4148 D3 100 F 100nF Q7 Q1 C8050 D1 © oatleyelectronics.com ZERO VR2 2k 1k 4148 1M 1M 1M 4148 10k + BLACK WIRE 47nF * DELETE TRIMPOT VR1 IF EXTERNAL THROTTLE USED * * REPLACE WITH WIRE LINK FOR 12V OPERATION * * * REPLACE RELAY LINK WITH 82  2W RESISTOR FOR 32V OPERATION LEADS TO MOTOR Fig.4: follow this parts layout diagram to build both versions of the controller (the non-reversible version uses only those parts to the left of the red dotted line). Note that some of the parts and linking options vary, depending on on whether the controller is to be powered from 12V, 24V or 32V. motor direction and this 4s period of time can be lengthened or shortened by respectively increasing or decreasing the value of the 47kΩ resistor. Now, when the motor voltage (and current) is zero, the RS flipflop can be toggled. So to change from forward to reverse direction, you press pushbutton switch S1. This not only pulls IC2a’s inputs low but also pulls pin 8 of IC2c low and this sets the flipflop so that it turns on transistor Q4 and energises the two relay coils. Note that as soon as you release pushbutton switch S1, it will immediately allow pins 1 & 2 of IC2a to go high again and this will cause pin 3 to go low. This will then reset the RS flipflop, thereby turning off transistor Q4 and lighting LED2, which indicates forward direction. Hence, for reverse operation, you need to keep the pushbutton pressed. This makes sense if you are making this speed control for an electric bi­ cycle and you only want reverse engaged for very limited time. However, if the speed control needs to be in reverse mode for much longer periods, the pushbutton switch is not practical and you will need to substitute a standard SPST toggle switch. Building it Both versions of the DC Motor Speed Control are available as kits from Oatley Electronics (see parts list). The reversible version is built on a double-sided PC board coded K275 (138 x 70mm), while the non- Table 1: Linking Options Supply Rail Relay Configuration Relay Link Resistor R1 12V 24V Link B & C, Link D & E Wire Link Wire Link Link C & D Wire Link 4.7kΩ 32V Link C & D 82Ω 2W Resistor 4.7kΩ 30  Silicon Chip reversible version (without the relays) uses a double-sided PC board coded K275A (60 x 70mm). Note that the parts layout on the latter is identical to the corresponding section on the fully-reversible version. Fig.4 shows the assembly details. If you are building the non-reversible version, just follow the layout to the left of the red dotted line. Conversely, for the reversible version, you will need to assemble the entire board. Begin by installing the resistors and diodes. Table 2 shows the resistor colour codes but check each resistor using a DMM before installing it. Note that resistor R1 (4.7kΩ, near LED1) should be replaced with a wire link for 12V operation. Conversely, you will need to install the resistor is you intend operating the controller from 24V or 32V. Be sure to install the correct diode type at each location and check that they are all correctly orientated. Diode D2 (SR1060) goes in with its metal tab adjacent to the edge of the PC board. Once these parts are in, install the siliconchip.com.au This view shows the reversible version. Note that you must fit M3 x 10mm screws to the BAT+, M-, GND and MOTOR positions to carry the high currents. It’s also a good idea to run a layer of solder over the high-current copper lands for currents above 15A – see text. capacitors and IC sockets. Check that the electrolytics are all correctly orientated and make sure that the sockets go in with their notched ends positioned as shown. Now for the transistors. These should all be pushed down onto the PC board as far as they will comfortably go before soldering their leads. Use the correct type at each location and take care with their orientation – the metal faces of Q2 & Q3 face the 100µF capacitor and LED1 respectively, while Q5’s metal side faces the adjacent 4.7kΩ resistor. Q4 goes in with its metal face towards the edge of the PC board. The two power Mosfets (Q6 & Q7) should now be loosely attached to their U-shaped heatsinks using M3 x VR1 (5kΩ) but you must leave this part out if you are using an external throttle to control motor speed. VR1 is installed only if you are using the controller to set a fixed motor speed (ie, no external throttle). The two ICs can now be plugged into their sockets (note: they face in opposite directions) and the relays installed. These relays will only fit 10mm machine screws, washers and nuts. That done, install each assembly in position and push it down until the bottom edge of its heatsink rests against the PC board. The heatsink tabs should go through the holes in the board and these should be bent using pliers to hold the assemblies in position while you solder the device leads. Bending the heatsink tabs will also make the assemblies more secure, particularly if the board will later be subject to vibration. Once everything is in place, tighten the screws that secure the Mosfet tabs to the heatsinks. Trimpot VR2 (2kΩ) can be installed and the board has been designed to accept either a horizontal or vertical trimpot. The same goes for trimpot Table 3: Capacitor Codes Value 100nF 47nF 4.7nF µF Value IEC Code EIA Code 0.1µF 100n 104 .047µF   47n 473 .0047µF   4n7 472 Table 2: Resistor Colour Codes o o o o o o o o o o o o o siliconchip.com.au No.   3   1   1   4   1   3   1   3   1   2   1   2 Value 1MΩ 220kΩ 47kΩ 39kΩ 10kΩ 4.7kΩ 3.3kΩ 2.7kΩ 2.2kΩ 1kΩ 470Ω 22Ω 4-Band Code (1%) brown black green brown red red yellow brown yellow violet orange brown orange white orange brown brown black orange brown yellow violet red brown orange orange red brown red violet red brown red red red brown brown black red brown yellow violet brown brown red red black brown 5-Band Code (1%) brown black black yellow brown red red black orange brown yellow violet black red brown orange white black red brown brown black black red brown yellow violet black brown brown orange orange black brown brown red violet black brown brown red red black brown brown brown black black brown brown yellow violet black black brown red red black gold brown August 2010  31 The basic non-reversible version is shown here, together with the optional handle-bar type (Hall effect) throttle. Be sure to omit trimpot VR1 from the board if you intend using an external throttle – see text. Parts List: Kit K275A 1 PC board, code K275A, 60 x 70mm 2 PC-mount 2-way screw terminal blocks 1 5kΩ trimpot (VR1) 1 2kΩ trimpot (VR2) 1 8-pin DIP IC socket 5 M3 x 10mm machine screws 5 M3 nuts 5 M3 washers 2 heatsinks Tinned copper wire for links Semiconductors 1 LM358 dual op amp (IC1) 1 C8050 NPN transistor (Q1) 2 BDX37 NPN transistor (Q2,Q5) 1 BD140 NPN transistor (Q3) 2 IRF2804 Mosfets (Q6,Q7) 1 15V zener diode (ZD1) 2 1N4148 small-signal diodes (D1,D7) 1 SR1060 Schottky diode (D2) 1 red 3mm LED (LED1) Capacitors 1 100µF 63V electrolytic 2 100µF 16V electrolytic 1 100nF monolithic 2 47nF monolithic 1 4.7nF greencap Resistors (0.25W, 5%) 3 1MΩ 1 3.3kΩ 1 220kΩ 1 2.2kΩ 2 39kΩ 2 1kΩ 1 10kΩ 1 470Ω 3 4.7kΩ 2 22Ω 32  Silicon Chip one way and you should use generous amounts of solder on their contact pins since they can carry quite high currents. Pushbutton switch S1 is the Forward/Reverse switch. This should only be installed on the board if you want a switch that you hold down for reverse operation (ie, if you only want reverse for a short time). However, as stated above, you will need to substitute a standard SPST toggle switch if you want reverse for extended periods of time. In that case, just connect the switch contacts to the appropriate pads on the PC board using flying leads. operation, depending on the supply voltage. For 12V operation, use separate wire links to connect points B & C together and points D & E together. Alternatively, for 24V or 32V operation, connect points C & D together (don’t forget to replace the Relay Link with an 82Ω 2W resistor for 32V operation – see above). Note that the two links installed for 12V operation overlap each other. Be sure to position them so that they cannot short together (or sleeve them with heatshrink, or use insulated wire). The final option concerns one of the 4.7kΩ resistors (R1) in series with LED1. As stated previously, this must be replaced with a wire link for 12V operation. Linking options High-current connections There are several linking options and component changes, depending on whether you are operating the controller from 12V, 24V or 32V. Table 1 shows the details. First, on the reversible version, you will need install the “Relay Link” at the top of the board (above the relays). This is simply a wire link for operation up to 24V but this must be replaced with an 82Ω 2W resistor (not supplied with the kit) for 32V operation. Similarly, you also need to link the relay coils for either parallel or series All connections to the motor and battery must be run via crimped eyelet connectors which are attached to the PC board using M3 x 10mm machine screws, washers and nuts. In addition, if building the reversible version, you must also fit an M3 x 10mm screw, washer and nut to the MOT- hole position, immediately to the left of relay RLY1A (see Fig.4). That last step is important because the screw through the MOT- hole helps carry the heavy currents that flow through the motor and power Forward/reverse switch siliconchip.com.au Mosfets Q6 & Q7. The same goes for the machine screws that are used to terminate the eyelets for the battery and motor connections. In short, you must have machine screws running through the BAT+, BAT-, MOT- and TO MOTOR holes to carry the heavy currents involved. Don’t just rely on the through-hole plating of the board – it could “fuse” under high-current conditions. If you are building the smaller nonreversible version, use the alternative BAT-, MOT- & BAT+ connections shown on Fig.4. The motor is connected between MOT- and BAT+. As before, all connections must be made via crimped eyelet connectors which are attached using M3 x 10mm screws, washers and nuts. Make sure that the leads are adequately rated to carry the currents involved. Generally, this will involve using heavy-duty cabling rated at 15A or greater if required. Finally, for currents above about 15A, run a thick layer of solder over all the high-current copper lands on the PC board. This must be done on both sides of the board and involves the lands running to the power Mosfets, the motor and battery connections and the relay contacts. Testing When the assembly is complete, check your work very carefully. Any mistakes in component placement or polarity could result in damage when the power supply is connected. Supply polarity is also crucial – getting it wrong can seriously damage the unit. Parts List: Kit K275 (Reversible Version) 1 PC board, code K275, 138 x 70mm 1 PC-mount tactile switch (S1) 2 PC-mount 2-way screw terminal blocks 1 5kΩ trimpot (VR1) 1 2kΩ trimpot (VR2) 1 8-pin DIP IC socket 1 14-pin DIP IC socket 4 12V 30A relays 7 M3 x 10mm machine screws 7 M3 nuts 7 M3 washers 2 heatsinks Tinned copper wire for links Semiconductors 1 LM358 dual op amp (IC1) 1 4093 quad 2-input NAND gate (IC2) 2 red 3mm LEDs (LED1, LED3) 1 green 3mm LED (LED2) 1 C8050 NPN transistor (Q1) 2 BDX37 NPN transistor (Q2,Q5) If everything checks OK, connect a 12V battery (or other high-current DC power supply) but do not connect the motor yet. Now check that +7V is present on the emitter of transistor Q1. If it is, set the throttle (either an external pot or VR1) to minimum and monitor the voltage at pin 7 of IC1. This voltage should vary as you vary the throttle and if you have an oscilloscope, you can check that the PWM duty cycle varies as shown on the scope screen shots of Fig.1 & Fig.2. Presensitized PCB & associated products 1 BD140 NPN transistor (Q3) 1 BD681 NPN Darlington transistor (Q4) 2 IRF2804 Mosfets (Q6,Q7) 1 15V zener diode (ZD1) 5 1N4148 small signal diodes (D1,D3-D5,D7) 1 SR1060 Schottky diode (D2) 1 1N4004 1A diode (D6) Capacitors 2 100µF 63V electrolytic 4 100µF 16V electrolytic 1 100nF monolithic 4 47nF monolithic 1 4.7nF greencap Resistors (0.25W, 5%) 5 1MΩ 1 3.3kΩ 1 220kΩ 3 2.7kΩ 1 47kΩ 1 2.2kΩ 4 39kΩ 2 1kΩ 1 10kΩ 1 470Ω 3 4.7kΩ 2 22Ω Next, set the throttle to minimum, connect a motor and connect your DMM (set to volts) across the motor’s terminals. Adjust trimpot VR2 for a reading of 0V – this will zero the controller’s output when the throttle is at minimum. Alternatively, you can set it to give a minimum motor speed. Now try adjusting the throttle. The motor should start and respond to throttle adjustments and the DMM should indicate corresponding voltage SC variations. IN STOCK NOW! •Single Sided Presensitized PCBs •Double Sided Presensitized PCBs •Fibreglass & Phenolic •UV Light Boxes •DP50 Developer •PCB Etch Tanks, Heaters & Aerator Pumps •Thermometers •Ammonium Persulphate Etchant •PCB Drill Bits (HSS & Tungsten) For full range, pricing and to buy now online, visit 36 Years Quality Service siliconchip.com.au www.wiltronics.com.au Ph: (03) 5334 2513 Email: sales<at>wiltronics.com.au August 2010  33 By NICHOLAS VINEN Remote-Controlled Digital Up/Down Timer This remote-controlled digital timer has a bright 20mm-high 7-segment red LED display & can count up or down from one second to 100 hours in 1-second steps. Its timing period can either be set and controlled using the remote control or it can be automatically controlled via external trigger/reset inputs. An internal relay and buzzer activate when the unit times out. T HIS NEW DIGITAL TIMER is a very flexible project. We can think of many uses for it but we are sure there are a lot more that we haven’t even considered. We’ve done lots of timers before but this one has the convenience of remote control. Its timing period can be programmed using the numerical keypad button on the remote, while the remote’s Power/Standby button provides a Reset function. 34  Silicon Chip The simplest way to use it is like a kitchen timer. In this mode, it can count up or down for the timing period, as entered via the keypad on the remote. Pressing the remote’s Channel Up button make the unit count up to the programmed time, while pressing the Channel Down button makes it count down. When the time runs out, the LED display flashes and a buzzer sounds for a preset period (the default is one minute) or until the reset button is pressed. You can either use the Power/ Standby button on the remote to reset the unit or an external reset button. The internal relay also switches at the end of the timing interval. This relay can directly control a DC device (30V DC or 24V AC max.) or it can indirectly control a mains-powered device via a separate external mainsrated relay (see panel). Note, however, that this unit is definitely NOT RATED siliconchip.com.au OUT A 100nF 470Ω 10k E B f PD2 IC1 ATTINY 2313 K D3 2 10k A 8 K 100nF 3 TRIG IN 1 PD4 D4 PA2/RST A PD5 2 +5V CON3 PD1 10k XTAL2 A 7 K PD3 D6 100nF XTAL1 GND 10 A D3–D6: 1N4148 A 2010 b c f e g d dp a K 9–12V DC IN b f g e c dp d g f e d c b a dp DISP3 NFD-5621BS a b f e c a b g d dp f e c g d a b f g e c d dp dp c dp e d g g f e d c b a dp b c dp f b a 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 15 14 13 12 11 16 17 18 19 2 1 +5V RLY1 K D2 9 CON1 A 3 COM NC NO K D5 SC  d + – 47 µF DISP2 NFD-8021BS a 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 PB3 PB2 PB1 PB0 PD6 PB4 PB5 PB6 PB7 PD0 +5V 3 g e 6 RESET IN a C 2 1 DISP1 NFD-8021BS 20 Vdd Q1 BC556 D1 D2 λ 1 A CON4 D1 D2 3 IN GND 100 µF +5V K K D2 D1 λ LED1 100nF IRD1 IR RECEIVER D1 REG1 7805T +5V 4 5 + COM NC NO PIEZO BUZZER X1 8MHz – 33pF 10k C B 33pF CON2 Q2 BC546 E D1, D2: 1N4004 A REMOTE-CONTROLLED DIGITAL TIMER LED K B K A 7805 BC546, BC556 E GND IN C GND OUT Fig.1: the circuit is based on an Atmel ATTiny2313 microcontroller (IC1), three dual 7-segment LED readouts and an infrared receiver (IRD1). The micro drives the LEDs, controls the timing and drives a DPDT relay via transistor Q2. to directly switch mains devices. By default, the relay is energised while the timer is running. As such, the timer could be used to run an oven for the programmed timing period, expose a PC board to UV light, or run a fan or light for a fixed period, etc. The trigger and reset inputs can be used to automatically start and stop the timer when certain events occur, eg, when a door opens, an external button is pressed or a PIR (passive infrared) sensor is triggered by motion, etc. This means that you could set it up to turn on a light or fan when a door is opened and then subsequently switch the device off when the door is shut or after the programmed period expires. It could even be used as the basis of a very simple alarm system. All you siliconchip.com.au have to do is connect a PIR sensor to the trigger input, a key-switch to the reset input and a siren to the relay. You then set the timer to a short period (say 30 seconds) and the alarm period to a value that’s longer than the default (say three minutes) and voila! . . . you have a basic motion-triggered alarm with key deactivation. By the way, the unit will work with virtually any universal remote control that’s capable of transmitting Philips RC5 codes (nearly all do). So if you have a spare universal remote control, it will do the job quite nicely. Circuit description Take a look now at Fig.1 for the full circuit details. It’s based on microcontroller IC1 plus three dual 7-segment LED readouts. However, instead of using a PIC micro as in most other projects, this time we’ve opted for an Atmel ATTiny2313 with 2048 bytes of flash memory. The micro normally runs at 8MHz, as set by an internal 8MHz oscillator and crystal X1. This clock frequency is reduced to 1MHz (via a clock divider) when the micro is in standby mode. Note that although the micro actually has an internal 8MHz oscillator, the crystal is necessary for accurate timekeeping. Typical crystal error is less than 100ppm or 0.01%, giving a maximum timing error is one second per three hours although it will normally be well under half that. The unusual part of this circuit is the way in which the six 7-segment August 2010  35 Parts List 1 PC board, code 19108101, 89 x 80mm 1 sealed polycarbonate enclosure, 115 x 90 x 55mm with clear lid (Jaycar HB-6246) 1 universal remote control with numeric keypad (eg, Jaycar AR-1726, Altronics A-1012) 1 9-12V DC 300mA plugpack (Jaycar MP-3147, Altronics M-8928 or similar) 1 6-way chassis-mount terminal barrier (Jaycar HM-3168, Altronics P-2076A) 1 5V DPDT DIL relay (Futurlec HFD2-05, Altronics S-4147 or equivalent) (RLY1) 1 PC-mount 5V mini piezoelectric buzzer (Jaycar AB-3459, Altronics S-6105) 1 8MHz HC-49 crystal resonator (X1) 1 20-pin DIL IC socket 3 mini 3-way terminal blocks (5.08mm pitch) (CON1-CON3 1 2-way polarised header (2.54mm pitch) (CON4) 1 2-way polarised header connector (2.54mm pitch) 1 2.1mm ID panel-mount DC socket (Jaycar PS-0522, Altronics P-0622) 4 M3 x 15mm tapped Nylon spacers 6 M3 x 20mm pan head machine screws 2 M3 nuts 2 M3 flat washers 2 M3 spring washers Medium-duty hook-up wire: 50mm lengths of black and red, 130mm lengths of brown, orange, yellow, green, blue and white LED digits (DISP1-3) are driven. Just 10 of IC1’s 20 pins are used to drive the 48 segments (seven per digit plus the six decimal points). What’s more, we have not used any discrete transistors or current limiting resistors in the LED drive circuit. This makes the project smaller, cheaper and easier to build but how do we get away with it? First, we are using a “charlieplexing” system (popularised by Charlie Allen at Maxim) which cuts down on the number of pins required to drive the LEDs. This is a special form of multiplexing and to understand how it works, first consider display DISP1. This contains two of the digits and has 10 pins – two common anodes and eight shared cathodes. If we wire up just this display, then turning on any single segment is easy. We start by pulling one of the common anodes pins high – pin 1 for the first digit or pin 2 for the second digit. We then drive one of the cathode pins low, so that one of the 16 LEDs in the display has a complete circuit, ie, is driven at both ends. This ensures that only that segment lights up. The other eight lines remain high impedance (“Tri-stated”) in order to avoid turning on any of the other segments. To drive the second display, we reuse the same set of pins on the micro but we use two different ones for driving the anodes. For example, here we are using pins 15 & 14 of the micro to drive the anodes in DISP1, while pins 11 & 12 drive the anodes in DISP2. 36  Silicon Chip Semiconductors 1 ATTiny2313 microcontroller (IC1) programmed with 1910810B.hex 1 7805T 5V regulator (REG1) 1 infrared receiver (IRD1) 1 BC556 PNP transistor (Q1) 1 BC546 NPN transistor (Q2) 2 7DR/NFD-8021BS 20mm dual high-brightness common anode 7-segment LED displays (DISP1-2) (available from Futurlec) 1 7DR/NFD-5621BS 14mm dual high-brightness common anode 7-segment LED display (DISP3) (available from Futurlec) 1 green 5mm LED (LED1) 2 1N4004 diodes (D1-D2) 4 1N4148 diodes (D3-D6) Capacitors 1 100µF 16V electrolytic 1 47µF 25V electrolytic 4 100nF MKT 2 33pF ceramic Resistors 4 10kΩ 1 470Ω With this arrangement, when any segment in display DISP1 is illuminated, there is also a voltage present across one of the segments within DISP2. However, because DISP2’s anode pins are connected only to DISP1’s cathodes, that LED is reverse biased and so it does not light. The same is true in reverse, ie, driving a segment in DISP2 will reverse bias a segment in DISP1. The same applies for DISP3, which has its anodes driven from pins 18 & 19 of the micro. As a result, no two common anodes are joined to the same microcontroller output. Thus, by being clever as to which lines are driven high and low at any one time (as set by the micro’s internal firmware) and leaving the rest at high impedance, we can light any one of the 48 segments. Multiplexing While this scheme theoretically allows us to light more than one segment at once (in fact we could light all the segments in a single digit quite easily), in practice we would need external anode driver transistors to do this. The microcontroller outputs simply can’t provide enough current to light multiple segments simultaneously, at least not without affecting their brightness. So each segment in the display is lit individually in sequence. Because this happens so rapidly, the persistence of vision effect in our eyes makes it appear as if all the segments are lit simultaneously. This is much the same technique that’s generally used to multiplex a multi-digit 7-segment LED display, except that normally all the segments of each digit are lit simultaneously. In this case, we have taken the multiplexing to its extreme and as a result, the individual segment duty cycle is less than 2%. In other words, each segment is lit for less than 1/50th of the total time. We can get away with this for two reasons. First, the LED displays are very bright, so despite each segment being lit for such a short period, they are still quite visible. Second, we are driving them above their rated DC current (but below their rated pulse current), thereby increasing their instantaneous (and thus average) brightness. This scheme has yet another advantage. Because the number of segments being lit at any one time never varies siliconchip.com.au (it’s always one), the displays do not vary their brightness according to the value. Look carefully at a commercial device with a 7-segment LED display (eg, a microwave or clock/radio) and you will find that in many cases, the brightness varies quite dramatically between a digit reading “1” and one reading “8”. Current limiting The microcontroller runs off a +5V rail (more on this later) and the LED segments have a typical forward voltage of around 2V. So how does the microcontroller drive the LEDs, or for that matter its internal output transistors, without burning them out? The answer is that these output transistors, for both the anode and cathode drive, have a fairly significant internal resistance. This limits the current to a safe level but only if the segment duty cycle is kept low. As mentioned earlier, the duty cycle has to be less than 2% due to the number of segments and calculations show that this is safe for both the micro and the displays. Let’s take a closer look at these calculations. The ATTiny2313 datasheet does not specify any dissipation limits but we can estimate them from its current limits. In this case, the maximum current per I/O pin is given as 40mA, while the maximum current for the entire micro is 200mA. By referring to the “I/O Pin Source Current vs. Output Voltage (VCC = 5V)” and “I/O Pin Sink Current vs. Output Voltage (VCC = 5V)” graphs, we can calculate the maximum average dissipation for the output transistors in the worst case temperature. This is 48mW for the pull-up transistors and 42mW for the pull-down transistors. Since it is permissible to have up to five I/O pins sourcing 40mA and five I/O pins sinking 40mA simultaneously (40mA x 5 = 200mA) then we can calculate that the maximum package dissipation must be at least (48mW + 42mW) x 5 = 450mW. Average dissipation We can now calculate the actual dissipation in the output transistors to check that it is safe. First, we assume that the voltage drop across each LED segment is around 2V. In reality, it will be higher than this due to the higher than normal current but using a 2V figure is the conservative approach. This means siliconchip.com.au Specifications Timing range: 1 second to 100 hours (360,000 seconds) in 1-second steps. Timing direction: unit can count up or down. Remote control: can be set and controlled using a universal remote control. External inputs: can be triggered and reset using external inputs; timer counts up or down from a preset value when externally triggered. Outputs: DPDT (double-pole double-throw) relay outputs – relay can be on or off while counting and then changes state for the duration of the alarm period. Relay contact rating: 30V DC or 24V AC (must NOT be used to switch mains appliances). Power supply: 9-12V DC 300mA plugpack or a battery. the current through the LED will be such that the sum of the voltage drops across the output transistors is 3V (ie, 5V - 2V). By referring to the sink and source graphs previously mentioned, we can calculate that the worst case current flow is 65mA at -40°C. The instantaneous dissipation will thus be 118mW in the source transistor, 130mW in the LED and 76mW in the sink transistor. Since the current source transistors have a duty cycle of no more than 1:6 (there are six digits) and the sink transistors have a duty cycle of no more than 1:8 (eight segments), we can calculate the maximum average dissipation figures. These turn out to be 19.7mW for the source transistors, 2.7mW for the LEDs and 9.5mW for the sink transistors. The total average dissipation in the microcontroller is just 194mW. These figures are all well below the maximum continuous ratings. So as long as we are careful to turn on each segment for just a short period (to prevent heat build up), then no damage should occur. In fact, in this design, each segment is lit for 10-20µs at a time and thus the refresh rate is around 1kHz. Measurements on the prototype confirm these calculations. With the microcontroller running at 8MHz and no segments lit, the current drain is around 12mA. Conversely, with all the segments lit, it is around 50mA. This suggests that the instantaneous current through each LED is in the range of 40-50mA, which is slightly less than we have calculated. Infrared remote control Control signals from the remote are picked up by infrared receiver IRD1 and fed to the PD2/INT0 input (pin 6) of IC1. IRD1 also drives LED1 (a green 5mm type) via PNP transistor Q1 and this LED flashes when ever an infrared transmission is received. However, it does not guarantee that there were no errors in the reception – if there are then IC1 will ignore the signal. LED1 simply flashes brightly when infrared (IR) data is received. A typical infrared remote control produces a modulated signal at around 36-38kHz. The IR receiver (IRD1) includes an internal 30-40kHz bandpass filter in order to remove any signals that may be present from flickering lights or other infrared sources. Unfortunately, while this filter does a good job of preventing unintentional signals from triggering its output, it is not perfect. As a result, some red light reflected back to the receiver from the LED displays can cause occasional false triggering and this can be made worse if there are lights shining directly on the unit, as their flickering can interact and produce beat frequencies. Ultimately, this isn’t a problem because the microcontroller recognises only legitimate 889µs-long control pulses and ignores the shorter pulses caused by interference. As a result, false triggering at the IR receiver’s output is rejected by the micro’s firmware and has no effect on the timer’s operation. Minor effects The false triggering does have two minor effects, though. One is that the onboard green LED can briefly flicker under some situations, as it directly monitors IRD1’s output. However, the LED lights much more brightly when August 2010  37 r emiT latigiD pih C no ciliS 8888 BUZZER 100nF 4148 4148 33pF x2 girT TRIG GND RESET t es eR D N GCON3 CON1 COM 5V DPDT RELAY LED1 RLY1 0102 © © 2010 DISP3 CON2 COM NC NC NO 88 NFD-5621BS 100nF 100nF 10k 10k 470Ω D4, D6 10k BC556 Q1 D2 BC546 4004 Q2 8MHz IRD1 19108101 10180140 + D3, D5 10k CON4 100nF IC1 ATTINY2313 4148 4148 47 µF 25V 7805T D1 4004 + POWER + – DISP2 NFD-8021BS 100 µF Silicon Chip Digital Timer NFD-8021BS DISP1 NO Fig.2: follow this parts layout diagram to build the PC board. Be careful not to get transistors Q1 & Q2 mixed up and note that the displays must be mounted with their decimal points towards the bottom. It is also switched alternately on and off at 1Hz to save power and make its sound more obvious. Note that its 1-minute period is the default value and this can be altered if necessary. Relay RLY1 (a standard 5V micro DPDT type) is driven from output PD5 (pin 9) of IC1, in this case via NPN transistor Q2. Diode D2 protects the transistor by quenching the back-EMF voltage spikes that are produced when the relay is switched off. All six relay contacts are connected to terminal blocks CON1 & CON2 so they can be connected to the output terminals on the outside of the case as you see fit. The trigger and reset inputs are provided via 3-way terminal block CON3 and a pair of RC filters (10kΩ and 100nF). These serve two purposes: (1) they filter out any noise or transients from the signals; and (2) in combination with diodes D3-D6, they protect IC1 from excessive voltage in either direction. As a result, it is safe to apply at least ±36V to either input. These inputs are connected to ports PD3 and PD4 (pins 7 & 8) of IC1. Voltages below 1.5V are considered “low” while voltages above 3V are considered “high”. The micro can be configured as to whether a low or high state activates the appropriate function (trigger or reset). PD3 and PD4 also have a weak pull-up resistor enabled within the microcontroller. This allows you to attach a switch, pushbutton or relay between the inputs and ground for passive triggering. In this case, you would configure the input as active-low for use with a normally open switch or active-high for use with a normally closed switch. Power supply This photo shows the fully-assembled prototype board. Note that there are a few minor differences between this board and the final version shown in the wiring diagram of Fig.2 the device is receiving genuine signals from the remote, so it’s easy to distinguish between the two situations. The second problem is that if there is a lot of light shining directly into the device, it can cause occasional reception errors when using the remote. Our tests have shown that the device can be reliably controlled from at least 5m away in most situations. It still works under adverse conditions but 38  Silicon Chip you may occasionally have to press a remote button more than once or correct a misinterpreted command when programming the unit. Support circuitry Pin 3 of IC1 drives the piezoelectric buzzer and this is activated for one minute at the end of the timing period. It is driven directly from output PD1 as it only consumes a few milliamps. Power for the unit can either be derived from a 9-12V DC 300mA plugpack or from a suitable 9-12V battery. The positive rail is fed in via diode DI, which provides reverse polarity protection, and applied to 3-terminal regulator REG1 (7805). REG1 then provides a regulated +5V rail to power the circuit (including the relays), while the 47µF and 100µF capacitors on either side of REG provide the necessary supply line filtering. The idle current is around 8.6mA and the maximum current drain is about 100mA with all LEDs lit, the relay on and the buzzer sounding. siliconchip.com.au Most of the idle current is consumed by the 7805 regulator (up to 6mA) and the infrared receiver (up to 4mA). If you want to power it from a battery, especially one comprising alkaline cells, it would be a good idea to replace D1 with a 1N5819 Schottky diode and REG1 with an LM2940IT-5 low drop-out regulator. The LM2940 has a slightly higher quiescent current but will allow the timer to run down to a much lower battery voltage. Board assembly Most the parts are installed on a PC board coded 19108101 and measuring 89 x 80mm. Begin by carefully checking the copper side for defects (breaks or short circuits), then check that all the holes have been drilled to the correct size. You may have to test fit some of the parts (eg, the terminal blocks and displays) to confirm this. Check also that the four corner mounting holes have been drilled to 3mm and that the board fits inside the plastic case. If it won’t go in, you may need to file the corners slightly. Fig.2 shows the parts layout on the PC board. Install the resistors first, followed by the four 1N4148 small signal diodes (D3-D6) which go in the middle of the board. The two larger 1N4004 diodes (D1 & D2) can then be installed. Make sure that all diodes are correctly orientated. Next, install the IC socket with its notch closest to D1 – see Fig.2. Solder its two diagonally opposite pins first, then make sure it’s sitting flat on the board before soldering the rest. The two ceramic and four MKT capacitors can then be installed. Follow these with the two transistors (Q1 & Q2). Note that Q1 is a PNP BC556 type while Q2 is an NPN BC546, so be careful not to get them mixed up. If their leads are too close together to fit through the holes on the board, crank them out with small pliers, then back down again so that they slide easily into place. Mounting the displays It’s now time to install the three dual The PC board is installed by fitting M3 x 15mm tapped Nylon spacers at each corner and then fastening it to the integral pillars in the case. Note that you will have to run the wiring to the DC socket and the barrier terminal strip before this is done. LED displays (leave the protective plastic on while you do this). For best appearance, they must sit perfectly flat against the PC board and should be parallel with the board edges. They also fit the board if installed upsidedown, so be careful with their orientation – the decimal points must be towards the bottom. Before mounting the displays, check that their pins haven’t been bent during transport. If so, they can be carefully straightened with pliers. Be sure to push each display all the way down so that it sits flush against the board. It’s best to solder two diagonally opposite pins first. That way, you can check that the display is correctly orientated and is flush with the board before soldering its remaining pins. The two electrolytic capacitors are next on the list. Check their polarity carefully when installing them and be careful not to get them mixed up. They should both be mounted about 3mm proud of the board so that they can later be bent over at about a 45° angle – see photos. That way, they won’t intrude on the display. Once these parts are in, install the green LED (LED1). This goes in with its flat (cathode) side towards 7-segment LED display DISP3. Push it all the way down onto the board and check its orientation before soldering its leads. Now for the infrared receiver (IRD1). Table 2: Capacitor Codes Value µF Value IEC Code EIA Code 100nF 0.1µF 100n 104 33pF   NA   33p   33 Table 1: Resistor Colour Codes o o o siliconchip.com.au No.   4   1 Value 10kΩ 470Ω 4-Band Code (1%) brown black orange brown yellow violet brown brown 5-Band Code (1%) brown black black red brown yellow violet black black brown August 2010  39 the programming pins are connected across LEDs. Install the hex file (available from the SILICON CHIP website) into its flash memory and don’t forget to set the fuse bits, which are documented in the accompanying text file, otherwise it may not work correctly. 6-WAY BARRIER TERMINAL STRIP Final assembly – 4148 + 4004 4148 88 COM girT TRIG RESET t es eR GND DNG NC NO COM NC 10180140 + 0102 © NFD-8021BS 8888 4148 4148 + 4004 DC INPUT SOCKET (REAR) NFD-8021BS r emiT latigiD pih C no ciliS NO Fig.3: here’s how to wire the DC input socket and connect the external Trigger & Reset inputs plus one pole of the relay to the 6-way barrier terminal strip. Alternatively, if you don’t need the Trigger & Reset inputs, you can connect both relay poles or you can use a second terminal strip. As shown in Fig.2, this is installed with its body flat against the PC board (domed lens facing upwards). This simply involves bending its leads down by 90° about 3mm away from its body before soldering it in position. The three screw terminal blocks (CON1-CON3) can now be soldered in. Note that CON1 & CON2 must be orientated so that their entry holes face away from the relay. Similarly, CON3 should be installed with its entry holes towards the adjacent edge of the board. Check that they sit flush against the board before soldering their pins. Follow these with the relay, which again should sit flat against the board. After that, fit the buzzer, which must be installed with its positive pin (indicated on the body) towards CON4. The 2-pin polarised header (CON4) can then go in – install it with its 40  Silicon Chip locking tab towards the adjacent edge of the board. The 8MHz crystal and the 7805T regulator are next. The crystal can go in either way around while the 7805T must go in with its metal tab towards the adjacent edge of the board. Solder the regulator’s leads, then bend it away from the displays at a 45° angle so that it doesn’t later impinge on display visibility. Microcontroller You can now complete the board assembly by installing the microcontroller. If it came pre-programmed (as in a kit), all you need to do is make sure its pins are straight and then push it down into the socket with the correct orientation. If you need to program it first, you must do it out-of-circuit as some of The PC board is designed to fit in a Jaycar HB-6246 polycarbonate case with clear lid. We have also produced a slightly modified board to suit the similar Altronics H-0324 box (both board patterns can be download from the SILICON CHIP website). Basically, you can customise the connections on the box to suit your needs. For example, if you want to power the unit from a battery you may decide to install an on/off switch to avoid draining the battery when you are not using it. And if you don’t need the trigger and reset connections (ie, you will be using the remote control only), then you won’t need to run leads from CON3 to an external connector. As shown in Fig.3, we used a 6-way chassis-mount terminal barrier to terminate the trigger/reset inputs and one relay pole. A 2.1mm chassis-mount DC socket mounted on one side of the case is used for the power input. This is connected to a polarised header plug via two short leads (red for positive, black for negative) which is then plugged into CON4. The second relay pole was not connected in our prototype. If you do want to connect it, there is room on the other (bottom) side of the case for a second terminal barrier. We left the bottom clear so that the completed unit can rest on a flat surface but if we were mounting it on a wall, the bottom would be the logical location for the connections to be made. Assuming you want to assemble your timer as shown in Fig.3, you will need to drill eight holes along the top edge of the box and one hole in the lefthand side for the DC connector. Fig.4 shows the drilling details. This can either be photocopied and the sections used as drilling templates or you can download the diagram from the SILICON CHIP website and print it out. You can attach the templates using adhesive tape. Make sure they are correctly positioned before drilling the holes (the terminal barrier and DC socket must both sit low enough to clear the PC board when it is installed siliconchip.com.au in the case). Drill small pilot holes at each location first, then enlarge them by stepping up to the correct drill size. Finally, deburr each hole using an oversize drill. The terminal barrier can now be pushed through and secured using two M3 x 20mm machine screws (one at either end). Use a flat washer under the head of each screw and a spring washer and nut inside the case. The DC socket can then be installed but you will have to discard its washer as the box is too thick for it. Do the nut up firmly so it can’t rotate. 4.75 9.5 A 9.5 B 4.75 9.5 B 9.5 B B 9.5 B 9.5 A B 13 BASE OF JAYCAR HB-6246 ENCLOSURE – LONG SIDE CL FULL ENCLOSURE MEASURES 115 x 90 x 55 HOLES A = 3.0mm DIA, HOLES B = 3.5mm DIA. CL Wiring It’s now just a matter of completing the wiring as shown in Fig.3, using medium-duty hook-up wire. Cut the wires to the lengths specified in the parts list, then strip and tin the ends before making the connections. The leads to the 6-way terminal barrier are soldered to the various tags, while the supply leads are crimped and soldered to the polarised header pins. These pins are then inserted into the plastic header shell (watch the polarity). Before soldering the supply lead to the DC socket, it’s a good idea to test the current drain. To do this, you will need a 9-15V DC supply, a multimeter and some alligator clip test leads. It’s then simply a matter of applying power with your multimeter (set to mA) connected in series with one of the supply rails. The current drain should be in the region of 10mA. If it’s significantly more, disconnect the supply and check for faults. If it is close to (or exactly), zero then you may have the supply leads transposed. Once the wiring to the terminal barrier and the DC socket is completed, the board can be installed in the case. To do this, first attach an M3 x 15mm tapped Nylon spacer to each corner of the board using M3 x 20mm machine screws. Wind the spacers all the way onto the screws but don’t tighten them – you must still be able to easily rotate the screw head. Next, attach the three leads to screw terminal block CON3 (it’s much more difficult to attach them once the board is in place). Having done that, route the soldered leads from the barrier terminal strip and the DC socket to either side of the case (see Fig.3), then lower the board into place until its mounting screws meet the integral pillars. siliconchip.com.au ALL DIMENSIONS IN MILLIMETRES C 11 BASE OF JAYCAR HB-6246 ENCLOSURE – SHORT SIDE HOLE C = 8mm DIA. Fig.4: these diagrams can be copied and used directly as drilling templates for the plastic case. Note that hole “C” is best made using a pilot drill and then enlarging it to size using a tapered reamer. The assembly can now be completed by tightening the four screws to hold the board in place, connecting the appropriate wires to the relay terminals (either CON1 or CON2, or both) and plugging the power connector into CON4. Check that the positive supply lead is closest to IC1 (this lead should also go back to the centre terminal of the DC socket). Finally, push any excess wire down under the board through the gaps on either side and install the lid (with the neoprene seal pressed into its channel). Waterproofing Since the box is IP65 rated (ie, water and dust proof), it’s possible to waterproof the timer if you wish to use it outdoors. However, because of the holes drilled for the barrier terminal strip and the DC socket, our prototype is more splash-proof than waterproof. If you like, you can apply silicone sealant to the inside of both connectors to improve this. The difficulty of properly waterproofing the timer is that all connections must be made via IP65-rated connectors or cable glands. Perhaps the easiest method is to install a small cable gland on one side of the box and pass a multi-core cable through it, carrying power and all the signal lines. With an 8-way cable, it’s possible to run the power, the two trigger wires (ground can be shared) and up to four relay connections. Getting the remote working To use the Digital Timer you will need a universal infrared remote control which is set to a standard Philips RC5 remote control code (this is the default in many cases). The green LED in the timer will flash whenever an IR signal from the remote control is detected. To test whether you are using the right code, simply point the remote at the timer (make sure it is switched on) and press some of the numeric buttons. The corresponding numbers should appear on the timer’s 7-segment displays. If they don’t, either the timer has a fault or the remote control is set to the wrong code. Try setting the remote to other Philips codes until you find the correct one. For example, the Digitech remote control pictured in this article August 2010  41 A barrier terminal strip on one end of the case can be used to terminate the external trigger & reset inputs plus one set of relay contacts, or you can use it to terminate both sets of relay contacts. Don’t forget the ratings sticker. (Jaycar Cat. AR-1726) should be set to TV code 103. Once it’s working and the correct numbers appear, press the Power/ Standby button on the remote to clear the display. Adjusting the settings Before putting the timer to work, you need to configure it for your application (unless you just want to use the default settings). The procedure is as follows: (1) Default settings: for the first set of options, refer to Table 3. Decide on the default settings you want, then enter the corresponding digits in turn, from the first digit through to the sixth. When you have entered all six digits, press the mute button on the remote. The display will now blank and your settings are saved. They can be updated at any time by repeating the above procedure. An example will make this clearer. Let’s say that you: (1) want the buzzer to sound at the end of the timing period, (2) want the relay to turn on at the end of the timing period (ie, for the duration of the alarm period), (3) want the trigger input active high, (4) the reset input active high, (5) the unit to count up when externally triggered and (6) the alarm period set to four minutes. In that case, it’s just a matter of pressing 1, 2, 2, 2, 0, 4 on Fig.5: these labels should be attached inside the lid and to the panel above the barrier terminal strip using silicone sealant. the remote in sequence, followed by the Mute button. (2) Adjusting the brightness: the next step is to set the display brightness. This is done using the Volume Up (increase brightness) and Volume Down (decrease brightness) buttons. There are 32 possible levels and the brightness can be changed either when the timer is running or while setting the timing period. Initially, you can just press some random number buttons to get digits on the display and adjust the brightness from there. That done, clear the display by pressing the Power/ Standby button then press the Mute button. Each time the device is powered up after this, it will automatically load the set brightness level. You can use the same procedure to change it again later, if necessary. (3) Automatic timing: the final setting is the timing period you want programmed in for automatic triggering. Enter the time using the keypad, keeping in mind that the first two large Table 3: Setting Up The Presets Digit Setting 0 means 1 Means (Default) 2 Means First Buzzer Always off On during alarm period N/A Second Relay Always off On while counting On during alarm period Third Trigger input Disabled Active low Active high Fourth Reset input Disabled Active low Active high Fifth When triggered Count up Count down N/A Sixth Alarm period Enter number of minutes (0-9) 42  Silicon Chip siliconchip.com.au Controlling Mains Or High-Current DC The relay used in this project is rated at 30VDC/2A and 125VAC/1A. However, as used here, it should not be used to switch any AC voltage higher than 24V. DO NOT under any circumstances use the on-board relay to switch 230V AC mains appliances – that would be quite dangerous. To switch a mains load, you will need to use the on-board relay to trigger an external mains-rated relay (mechanical or solid state). This must be mounted and wired in a safe manner. Don’t attempt to do this unless you know exactly what you are doing and are experienced with 230VAC wiring! You can also use an external relay if you need to switch high-current DC. If you plan on adding an external relay, it’s best to use one with a 12V DC coil and run the Digital Timer from a 12V DC supply. It is then simply a matter of connecting the timer’s 12V rail to one of its internal relay’s COM contacts (either on CON1 or CON2). The positive side of the external relay’s coil is then connected to the corresponding NO contact, while the negative side goes directly to the negative output of the 12V DC supply. A reverse-biased diode should be connected across the external relay’s coil to quench switching spikes. Now when the internal relay switches on, it supplies power to the external relay’s coil and it too switches on. The contacts of the external relay can then be used to switch on a mains device or supply power to a high-current DC load (provided these contacts are adequately rated). Keep in mind that your 12V DC supply must be able to provide at least 100mA for the Digital Timer itself plus the rated coil current of your external relay. A 300mA plugpack supply should do the job quite nicely. digits represent the number of hours, the next two the number of minutes and the two smaller digits the number of seconds. Then press the “1-” key on the remote (the one normally used to enter 2-digit TV station numbers). This programmed time will now be placed in memory and recalled whenever the timer is started via its trigger input. Using the timer manually To use the timer manually, simply enter the timing period you want using the keypad, then press either the “Channel Up” or “Channel Down” button. If you press “Channel Up”, the display will start at 00:00:00 and count up to the timing value you have entered. Alternatively, if “Channel Down” is pressed, the display will start at the timing value you have specified and count down to 00:00:00. When the timing period ends, the alarm period will begin (unless it has been set to 0 minutes in which case the timer will immediately reset). When the alarm period expires, the unit resets automatically or you can press the Power/Standby button to reset it before it expires. If you want to stop counting simply press the remote’s Power/Standby button and the device will reset and go to siliconchip.com.au Charlieplexing Earlier in the article, we referred to the method used to drive the LED displays as “charlieplexing”, which is really just a special form of multiplexing. If you want to know more about charlieplexing, refer to our feature in the forthcoming September 2010 issue of SILICON CHIP. standby mode. You can also pause the timer by pressing the pause button (assuming your remote control has it – it is actually a VCR function). To resume, press play (another VCR function). Note that the buzzer is quite audible but not particularly loud once it is sealed inside the box. If you want to make it louder, drill some small holes in the lid immediately above the buzzer’s location. Finally, Fig.5 shows some labels which should be affixed to the inside lid of the case and to the panel immediately above the barrier strip terminal. These indicate the power supply requirements (and polarity) and also indicate the maximum voltage ratings for the relay contacts. That’s it! We are sure you can think SC of many uses for this project. Helping to put you in Control Control Equipment Relayduino The KTA-225 is a new version of our popular Arduino compatible USB controller featured in SC April 2010. Features ASCII Commands, 8 Relays, 8 Flexible I/O (Digital Input or Analog Input (05V/4-20mA). Windows/Mac/Linux compatible . $135+GST Rolls Of Heatshrink We now have rolls of heatshrink available. Colours of red, black, blue, yellow, green, white and clear available Diameters from 1.5/0.75 to 50/25mm From $75.00 +GST Industrial Grade Switches and Indicators We now have a selection of 22 mm diameter industrial switches. Fitted with NO+NC contacts. Screw Connections. Color Black, Red, Green, Yellow and Blue From $9.95 +GST DIN Rail Enclosure An ABS plastic enclosure that can be bolted to a panel or mounted on DIN rail Size: 145x90x40mm From $12.95 +GST 70W Brushed DC Servo Motor CNC Kit This 3-axis CNC kit contains all the drives, motors power supplies to build or retrofit a mill or lathe for CNC work. $929+GST Isolated RS232 to RS422/485 Converter A high performance RS-232 to RS485/422 converter. Features both 2.5KV opto-electrical isolation and internal power isolation $75+GST Ph: 03 9782 5882 New, Easier to Use Website www.oceancontrols.com.au August 2010  43 SERVICEMAN'S LOG Consumer gear that’s faulty out of the box It’s not often these days that electronics gear is faulty out of the box but it does happen. Usually, we return the item for an exchange or refund but what happens if you’ve left it too long and lost the receipt into the bargain? In this business, I get volunteered for all sorts of things – especially by Mrs Serviceman Recently, at her request, I bought two digital mains timer switches for an elderly relative. Unfortunately, he left them unopened for several months and when he finally got around to trying them out, it soon became apparent that one of them was faulty. By then, the receipt had been well and truly lost and so Mrs Serviceman thought it would be a good idea for me to fix it. After all, I was the one who had bought the timers, so it was my fault in the first place. That’s logical. While the digital timer portion of the device seemed to work fine, the actual mains switching did not. The working unit’s relay would click each time the output was switched on or off via the manual control pushbutton. By contrast, the faulty device would click twice when it was switched on but there was no output at any time. In addition, there was no sound from the relay when it was switched off. Luckily, this wasn’t one of those plastic cases that is glued shut and has to be mangled to be opened. After removing a few screws from 44  Silicon Chip the back, it snapped open to reveal two PC boards. One of these was attached to the inside front face and carried the LCD, pushbutton switches and control electronics. The other board was attached to the rear of the case and carried the power supply circuitry and the mains relay. I traced the layout of the main board and discovered that the power supply consisted of a 330nF X2 mains capacitor in series with the Active wire, followed by four 1N4004 diodes in a bridge rectifier configuration, then a 100µF 50V capacitor in parallel with a 36V zener diode to Neutral. A lowvalue 1W resistor is in series with the Neutral side of the circuit to limit the inrush current, while the X2 capacitor has a parallel high-value resistor to discharge it when the power is switched off. In addition to the power supply and relay, the only remaining circuitry was an NPN transistor to drive the relay and a PC-mount trickle-charged 1.2V NiMH cell for powering the control board. The boards were connected via a 3-pin header and cable – two wires for powering the control board and one for driving the transistor that powers the relay. Another interesting discovery was siliconchip.com.au that the relay was a 48V type, while the supply seemed to be regulated to 36V. Most relays are guaranteed to switch at approximately 75% of their rated voltage, which is why this circuit still works but I think I would have designed it a little more conservatively to allow more room for component tolerances. Not wishing to risk applying mains power with the case open and not having a convenient source of 36VDC, I turned my bench supply up to its maximum 30V output and connected it across the zener diode. This proved to be enough to switch the relay but only when it was orientated so that gravity would assist its switching. Fortunately, that was enough to allow me to determine that with this new power source, the unit worked correctly. Pressing the manual on/off button toggled the relay normally. So it seemed that the fault was in the power supply section. Because they have a reputation for unreliability I decided to first replace the 100µF electrolytic capacitor. My reasoning was that it may be low in value and not providing sufficient current to keep the relay energised. However, that didn’t help and the capacitor that had been removed tested OK. The only other component that could explain this fault in the power supply was the 330nF X2 capacitor. However, these are designed to be reliable enough to be used across mains conductors, so surely that couldn’t be it? Despite my doubts, I removed the X2 capacitor and checked its value. It read 120nF which is just over a third of what it should have been! So now it was clear why the device was behaving as it was. While the supply was able to charge up to 36V initially, the voltage dropped significantly when the relay was turned on because of the higher impedance of the X2 capacitor. In fact, it was dropping so far that the relay could not be kept closed. This explained the double click at turn on and explained why the output did not switch on properly. I replaced the X2 capacitor with a new one and it worked perfectly. Did something cause this capacitor to fail? It’s hard to say but its failure mode would appear to be consistent with the concept of X2 capacitor safety – it’s better for it to lose some of its capacitance rather than go short circuit if it’s going to be installed across the mains. However, I am suspicious that the capacitor used was of low quality. It weighed a fraction as much as its replacement! My next two stories are from T. T. of Woorim, Qld who has had some interesting encounters with marine electronics. Here’s how he tells them . . . A shocking winch In remote anchorages, a cruising yachtsman with some electrical knowledge gathers lots of friends, deals with lots of corroded wires and takes on a few challenging problems. In one recent case, Don got me Items Covered This Month • • • • • Faulty digital mains timer A shocking winch Faulty marine transceiver Timing the doors on a lift Sorting out a PA system aboard his boat to look at his anchor winch. “Every time I pull up the anchor, I get a belt from the forestay,” he said as he invited me up to the bow. “Go on, give it a try!” Not being particularly partial to “belts”, I gingerly took up the normal stance for winching up an anchor – one foot on the deck switch, one hand on the rail and the other hand holding the forestay so that one can hang over the side of the yacht to see what’s happening. This shouldn’t be too bad I reasoned – after all, it’s a 12V system and the stay and rail are earthed, so how could I get a shock at all? Anyway, I pressed the switch, the winch motor hummed, the chain clanked through the gypsy and . . . no shock. “Seems OK to me,” I said, taking my foot off the switch. WHAM! That felt like several thousand volts alright! Don gave a satisfied grin. “Didn’t believe me, did you?” Inside the yacht, we took off the small cover between the front cabin and the chain locker to gain access to the winch motor. I then squeezed my head and shoulders through the New Lower DSO Prices for 2010! Shop On-Line at emona.com.au GW GDS-1022 25MHz RIGOL DS-1052E 50MHz RIGOL DS-1102E 100MHz 25MHz Bandwidth, 2 Ch 250MS/s Real Time Sampling USB Device & SD Card Slot 50MHz Bandwidth, 2 Ch 1GS/s Real Time Sampling USB Device, USB Host & PictBridge 100MHz Bandwidth, 2 Ch 1GS/s Real Time Sampling USB Device, USB Host & PictBridge Sydney Brisbane Perth ONLY $499 inc GST Melbourne Tel 02 9519 3933 Tel 03 9889 0427 Fax 02 9550 1378 Fax 03 9889 0715 email testinst<at>emona.com.au siliconchip.com.au ONLY $713 inc GST Tel 07 3275 2183 Fax 07 3275 2196 Adelaide Tel 08 8363 5733 Fax 08 8363 5799 ONLY $966 inc GST Tel 08 9361 4200 Fax 08 9361 4300 web www.emona.com.au EMONA August 2010  45 Serr v ice Se ceman’s man’s Log – continued opening to be greeted by the strangest winch motor I had ever seen. “Oh, its a converted aircraft starter motor . . . we needed something really powerful for all this chain we carry”, Don told me. Because I had received the shock when the current flow had stopped, it was obvious that the collapsing magnetic field had induced a high voltage in the motor’s winding. It was similar to the way a high voltage is produced by a car’s ignition coil when the supply is interrupted (eg, by a transistor switching off or, in ancient cars, the points opening). This problem could occur with any motor but in this case, the particular installation made things worse. An aircraft motor has large multi-turn windings and is operated at high RPM through a gearbox, so that explained the source of the problem. The high induced voltage was sparking to the motor frame which was fixed to the deck just under the forestay. I had a large diode left over from a solar panel installation and this was duly fitted across the supply wires at the motor terminals. This was normally reverse biased, just like a diode fitted across a relay coil, but would quench any back-EMF that was generated when the motor turned off. Don had been imagining fitting thick pieces of insulation between the motor and the deck, or having the motor rewound because it was faulty. You can imagine his relief when a $2 diode did the trick. Faulty marine transceiver Radios are another common source of problems in the marine environment. After all, complex electronics and sea air are never a good mix. Simon’s VHF transceiver wouldn’t transmit or receive. All the correct LEDs on the front panel were lighting Servicing Stories Wanted Do you have any good servicing stories that you would like to share in The Serviceman column in SILICON CHIP? If so, why not send those stories in to us? In doesn’t matter what the story is about as long as it’s in some way related to the electronics or electrical industries, to computers or even to car electronics. We pay for all contributions published but please note that your material must be original. Send your contribution by email to: editor<at>siliconchip.com.au and be sure to include your full name and address details. 46  Silicon Chip at the right times and the display was fine, so my first thought was that it had to be the antenna. As a result, I removed the radio from the wooden panel above the navigation desk and unscrewed the PL259 plug from the antenna socket. The problem was immediately evident – a greenish liquid was oozing from the plug, something I had seen several times before. “The coax cable attached to the aerial at the top of the mast hasn’t been sealed and water has wicked its way right down to the radio”, I told him, “You’ll need to replace the entire length”. Next, I examined the radio itself, as the salt water from the coax often gets inside the case and literally eats through component leads and PC board tracks. In this instance, only the socket itself was corroded and this was easily replaced. A new length of RG213/U coaxial cable was also purchased but that was the easy part. Not quite so easy was the trip to the top of the mast, where you sit in an uncomfortable little bosun’s chair suspended from the end of the mainsail halyard. What seems to be a lovely, calm anchorage at deck level isn’t quite so attractive when you are 20 metres above the water, swaying several metres from left to right every few seconds, legs clamped around the mast and trying desperately not to drop that little grub screw. A few turns of self-amalgamating tape (missing in the previous installation) sealed the joint and a quick “radio check” call to the Volunteer Marine Rescue about 15 nautical miles away confirmed that we were indeed back on the air. An up-lifting story This story comes from G. L. of Carrum Downs in Victoria. Did you know that you could alter the timing of lift doors by jumping up and down? Neither did he, as he explains . . . As a long-time reader of SILICON CHIP, I have read many Serviceman’s Log columns and have great empathy with his trials and tribulations, especially when it comes to dealing with customers. In my case, I work as a Lift Mechanic, installing and servicing lifts. This involves both electrical and mechanical work and as you can imagine, a lot of the work is fairly routine. But not siliconchip.com.au siliconchip.com.au ACOUSTICS SB all – the following tale is from my time in our service department. One day, I was issued a call-out to investigate a lift that apparently had timing issues with the way the doors opened and closed. This was an older building with relay-logic lift controllers. In these units, the door dwell time (ie, the time the door stays fully open) is set by an RC network. This period could alter over time due to the electrolytic timing capacitor getting a bit leaky or even due to mechanical binding in the relay, depending on its type. On arrival at the job, I was met by the employee who had reported the fault and his manager. Now, at this point I should point out that this building was inhabited by state government public servants. What’s more, these two particular public servants must have trained in lift technology because they seemed to think they knew something about the subject – perhaps even more than I! In due course, the three of us entered the troublesome lift so that the expert could show me just what his extensive testing had revealed. According to him, if you let the doors open and close by themselves without human intervention, they stayed open “a very long time”. I nodded my head at this and instructed him to proceed with his story. He then stated, that he could make the doors close faster using a special technique that he had researched and tested over the last few days. I must say that his manager appeared suitably impressed with this highlyskilled employee but I wasn’t so sure. “OK”, I said, “please show me how you speed up the doors”, whereupon he walked to the rear righthand corner of the lift and proudly announced “Watch this!” The lift door opened and he immediately jumped up and down until it started to close! “See it closes quicker if you jump!” His manager looked even prouder now, especially as this guy had spent days working this out. I was not so impressed with his claim and immediately proceeded to explain how the door timing actually worked. It was a waste of time, as they both quickly assumed the look of my Labrador when I talk to it. All they heard was “blah-blah capacitor, blah-blah relay, blah-blah discharge time” – in short, they didn’t really try to comprehend a word I said. They then pointed out that I was wrong, with nice smirks on their faces. After all, what would I know? I was just the lift mechanic. “OK”, I said, “let’s just try this. We’ll let the door open and close naturally and time it with a watch”. Well, we did this and this produced a 6-second dwell time (ie, the door stayed open for six seconds). “ Now” I said, “let’s time it using your jump method to reduce the door open time”. Our expert jumped up and down for all he was worth but to their amazement, it was still six seconds! We had to repeat this quite a few times until they eventually got the idea that jumping up and down does not alter a capacitor’s discharge time! By now, the smirks had disappeared and the manager apologised for wasting my time. And as they trotted off back into the building, I heard the manager jokingly threaten to reassign his jumping colleague “to the mail dynamica August 2010  47 Serr v ice Se ceman’s man’s Log – continued room for all eternity”. In some ways, it would have been a fitting punishment. My next story comes from a contributor in Western Australia and concerns a PA system. Here it is . . . Sorting out a PA system A comment in an earlier issue about “a mate who knows someone who knows someone” reminded me of a curious PA system fault in a country church. Country people often struggle to get access all kinds of services, including electronic expertise. However, there’s always a local “mate” to do the job for you. In this case, the PA had been installed by one such mate, who was asked to do the job on the basis that he “fiddled with electronics”. Some time later, when I came on the scene, I found that the PA system had a bad hum and that it sounded rather “muddy”. Apparently, everyone had put up with it because they thought it was the best they could expect, especially when a mate had installed it. My first thought was that the hum was most likely caused by a broken microphone lead on the offending input. Checking the mike sockets revealed unbalanced 6.35mm mono jacks wired with ordinary coax cable – great for TVs and 2-way radios but not so good for balanced audio inputs. The offending input’s cable also happened to be the longest run (into inaccessible roof space) and was also placed right on top of mains cable. The easiest option was to try to convert this run into a balanced line using a balancing transformer at the mike socket. This reduced the hum quite a bit but not as much as I’d hoped. Lowlevel hum was still audible and the occasional electric motor whine also intruded. Apparently, the shield was picking up more noise than the centre conductor, leaving some imbalance. This now left the difficult option, which was to completely rewire the system with twin-shielded cable and replace the mono jacks with standard XLR connectors. Re-wiring with twin-shielded cable involved erecting scaffolding so that it could be safely run across a high ceiling. It was duly installed after some effort and the coax cable to the remaining inputs was replaced as well. In addition, the 6.35mm jacks were all replaced with standard XLR sockets. Problem solved, or so I thought. Well, it wasn’t. Not only was the hum still there but when I moved the microphone around, there was even more hum than before – except this time on a different channel to the one the mike was plugged into! This was starting to look very strange. I rechecked the wiring of the newlywired XLR sockets to make sure I hadn’t accidentally unbalanced what should have been a balanced lead but all was good. Where to now? Perhaps by solving a hum problem on one channel I’d either introduced or exposed a similar problem on the other. However, the wiring to this input was a much shorter run and not near any mains cable. And in any event, it was now twin-shielded cable. By now, it was starting to look like an earthing problem in the amplifier. A quick multimeter check on all its XLR sockets revealed that pin 1 was earthed in each case, which is normal – except that nothing was behaving normally. Since just any earth isn’t good enough as far as low-level audio is concerned, it was all starting to look too difficult and the thought of purchasing a new amplifier quickly crossed my mind. However, this job was a labour of love and besides that, the amplifier was now misbehaving worse than before I started. This was rather embarrassing and so I persisted. The PA amplifier itself was modular, with the XLR sockets on a separate input board at the back of the chassis. This is connected to the main board by a ribbon cable, so there were several possibilities here for a problematic earth connection. I now spent a very long time examining the PC tracks through a maggy lamp but this revealed nothing obvious – not that dry joints are always obvious. Tapping, prodding and poking also revealed nothing so all that was left was to resolder all the earth connections in the low-signal circuitry in the hope that this would fix the problem. And that’s when I came across a possible dry joint on a link from the preamplifier section earth to the main earth run on the PC board. As a result, I resoldered all the earth connections and that fixed the hum problem. The amplifier is now as quiet as a mouse, with not a trace of hum. So was the original unbalanced microphone cabling capable of working hum-free, with the problem only in the PA amplifier? It’s quite possible that it had all worked correctly when it was first installed, with the amplifier developing its dry-joint fault some time later. That aside, resoldering the earth connections in the amplifier and using twin-shielded cabling has certainly done the trick. What’s more, the new cabling will provide the best possible immunity to noise pickup. Now all I have to do is solve the question as to why our local expert would connect both low impedance and 100V line speakers to the amplifier SC when the handbook says not to. Issues Getting Dog-Eared? Keep your copies of SILICON CHIP safe, secure and always available with these handy binders REAL VALUE AT $14.95 PLUS P & P Available Aust, only. Price: $A14.95 plus $10 p&p per order (includes GST). Just fill in and mail the handy order form in this issue; or fax (02) 9939 2648; or call (02) 9939 3295 and quote your credit card number. 48  Silicon Chip siliconchip.com.au 12VDC Voltage Polarity Easy Tester 1:10 Scale Remote Control Off-road Electric Cars Don't be fooled by the price tag, these are serious 1:10 scale electric off-road remote control racing cars! Each is constructed around a lightweight hardened plastic chassis, and features front and rear fully adjustable independent suspension with oildampened shock absorbers, full-time shaft-driven 4WD with front and rear geared differentials, lightweight aluminium top plate for FROM extra chassis strength, hi-speed 00 $ steering servo, electronic speed controller (ESC) and hi-torque RC540 brushed motor. Both the buggy and monster truck are supplied fully assembled and "readyto-race", complete with 7.2V 1800mAH NiMH rechargeable battery pack and mains charger. Requires 8 x AA batteries for the Perfect Gift controller. Recommended for ages 12+. for Dad this See website for full specifications. Father’s Day! 199 1:10 Electric Buggy GT-3670 Was $229.00 Now $199.00 Save $30.00 1:10 Electric Monster Truck GT-3672 Was $249.00 Now $219.00 Save $30.00 SAVE $$$ RC Helicopter Sale 3 Channel Shark Helicopter with Alloy Frame All aluminium airframe, fuselage and landing gear make this chopper more than a toy and suitable for outdoor flying in calm conditions. A great challenge for the more experienced pilot. • Li-Po battery recharges in about 20 minutes to give about 10 minutes flight time • Remote requires 4 x AA batteries • Trim control • Plugpack charger included • 380mm long • Recommended for ages 14+ GT-3380 Was $79.95 Limited stock 69 95 $ SAVE 10 00 $ 2.4GHz Mini 4 Channel Helicopter Very stable and easy to fly, probably the best chopper we've had so far. Four channels gives you complete control for complex and accurate manoeuvring, takeoff and landings. The body is made from Lexan so is very flexible and strong. • 18 minute charge gives about 10 minutes flying time. • Remote requires 4 x AA batteries. • Measures 185(L)mm approx. • Recommended for ages 10+ GT-3384 WAS $149.00 DEALS TO WARM YOU UP THIS WINTER! Rotary Tool Kit with Flexible Shaft Flexible shafts have a multitude of uses. The kit consists of a powerful 32,000 RPM rotary tool that you can 95 $ use with numerous attachments in the usual way, plus a 1m long flexible shaft that attaches in seconds to give extra versatility. Suitable for model making, automotive, workshop, art, jewellery or sculpture. See website for full kit contents. TD-2459 Due Mid August 44 Remote-Controlled Digital Timer Refer: Silicon Chip Magazine August 2010 Remote-controlled digital timer with a bright 20mm-high 7-segment red LED display. It can count up or down from one second to 100 hours in 1-second increments. Its timing period can either be set and controlled using the remote control or it can be automatically controlled via external trigger/reset inputs. An internal relay and buzzer activate when the unit times out. The relay contacts can be used to switch devices rated up to 30VDC or 24VAC and the project can be powered from a plugpack or a battery. Short form kit only - you'll need to add your own universal remote, power supply & enclosure. • 9-12VDC <at>300mA • PCB and components KC-5496 39 $ This fantastic luxury supercar replica of the Lamborghini Reventón will not disappoint you! It features detailed bodywork, adjustable steering bias, built-in 500mAH battery (recharges in 5-6 hours) and a see through engine bay. Perfect for the Dad who dreams of owning a luxury car! 119 00 SAVE 30 00 $ • 27MHz • Remote requires 1 x 9V battery • Suitable for ages 8+ GT-3694 WAS $59.95 www.jaycar.com.au 24 • Dimensions: 51(L) x 44(W) x 29(H)mm Great gift idea for QP-2215 Father’s Day Weather Station LCD Keyring A weather station that fits in the palm of your hand, it shows forecast, temperature, humidity, time, date and moon phase. It also has an alarm clock with snooze button. Complete with inbuilt LED torch and compass. • Batteries included • Celsius or Fahrenheit • Max/min temperature 95 $ and humidity memory • Dimensions: 93(H) x 50(W) x 18(D)mm XC-0341 19 Twinkle Laser Systems with DMX Control Whether staging a dance club or house party, these laser light projectors help create the perfect dance floor atmosphere. They produce truly spectacular lighting effects with plenty of geometric patterns and overall effects to choose from. Three models available: Red Twinkle DMX Laser Light Show SL-3431 $149.00 • Dimensions: 205(L) x 80(W) x 145(H)mm Green Twinkle DMX Laser Light Show SL-3433 $149.00 • Dimensions: 205(L) x 80(W) x 145(H)mm Combo Red & Green DMX Laser Light Show with Blue LED SL-3435 $299.00 • Dimensions: 200(L) x 85(W) x 158(H)mm 95 1:18 Scale RC Lamborghini Supercar $ A passive, quick and easy testing solution that performs five essential tests in the field: voltage, load, polarity, voltage drop and continuity. The load applied is selectable between 1A or 500mA to test wiring depending on location, device to be tested, and anticipated voltage drop. The illuminated power connector clearly displays polarity. Ideal for CCTV and security installers, car audio, roadies, 95 $ AV techs etc. 149 00 NEW LYNN STORE - NEW ZEALAND 49 95 $ SAVE 10 00 $ FROM $ To order call 1800 022 888 Prices valid until 23/08/2010. Limited stock on sale items. No rainchecks. All Savings are based on Original RRP 2171 Great North Rd New Lynn Auckland 0600 Ph: (09) 828 8096 Opens early August! 2 Take the pain out of cable installation. Instead of trying to pound away with a hammer, simply staple the cable to eaves, rafters or joists. The staples have an integral plastic cable clamp that holds the cable firmly in place. Each gun takes a variety of staples sizes to accommodate cables up to 12.5mm diameter. An environmentally friendly DMM with rechargeable batteries that can be charged from the built-in solar panel, 12-36VDC or from mains power. Never have to buy batteries again. 00 $ FROM 19 95 $ Cable Staple Gun 4-10mm TH-2610 $19.95 Includes gun, 2 interchangeable blades and 200 staples. Cable Staples Refill 4-6mm Pk 200 TH-2611 $9.95 Cable Staples Refill 6-8mm Pk 200 TH-2612 $9.95 Heavy Duty Staple Gun Kit 4-12.5mm TH-2615 $49.95 Includes heavy duty die cast gun, 3 interchangeable blades and 200 staples in a carry case. Cable Staples Refill 8-9mm Pk 200 TH-2616 $9.95 Cable Staples Refill 9.5-11mm Pk 200 TH-2617 $9.95 Cable Staples Refill 11.5-12.5mm Pk 200 TH-2618 $9.95 TOOLS Multifunction LED Controller with Remote Great for applications like back lighting, mood lighting and commercial signage. Comes complete with a wireless remote control, so you can adjust your LED effects from a distance of up to 50 metres. Features adjustable 12 modes, 8 speeds, pause and brightness control. Unit requires 12-24V supply and will provide up to 5A maximum load per channel. See our website for compatible LED modules. • Dimensions: 211(L) x 40(W) x 30(H)mm MP-3275 79 95 $ 188pc Rotary Tool Accessories Pack At substantially lower cost than the hardware store brands and with 188 pieces, this kit will service every rotary tool bit you'll ever need. Everything is housed in a case so you can see exactly where all the bits belong. Sanding, grinding, cutting and polishing attachments. See website for full list of contents. TD-2458 19 $ • Category: Cat III 600V • Display: 2000 count • Size: 179(H) x 88(W) x 39(D)mm QM-1546 WAS $119.00 Intelligent semiconductor analyser that offers simple identification and testing for a variety of 2 or 3-pin devices. Type and lead identification as well as forward voltage, test current and other parameters for transistors. 95 SAVE 24 $ 00 Autoranging Pocket DMM A handy test instrument worthy of any professional tradesman or handyman's tool kit. This unit has an easy one finger dial selector on the front leaving your other hand free. Trade Quality 1000V Digital Multimeter • Backlit LCD • Laser accuracy • Dimensions: 110(L) x 47(W) x 28(H)mm QM-1621 A true RMS DMM purpose built for professional applications. With an ergonomic slimline yet robust design, it has overload protection, easy battery replacement, and comes supplied with a protective holster and test lead. A trustworthy instrument for apprentices and seasoned $129 00 tradesmen alike. Designed for recording and logging sound pressure level measurements for quality control, illness prevention, acoustic design or any other type of environmental sound measurement in domestic or industrial applications. The memory is able to record up to 129,920 samples with A or C weighting at intervals from 1 second to 24 hours and downloaded to a PC for later analysis. Modified to calculate SPL via proper log averaging rather than the inaccurate arithmetic average used on the original design. Battery and windsock included. SAVE 149 00 A multi-function environment meter that combines the functions of a sound level meter, light meter, humidity meter and temperature meter. Typical sound applications include checking acoustics of recording studios, auditoriums and professional hi-fi installations. The light and humidity meters are ideal for video photographers, greenhouse and hydroponic setups, etc. Others who should find this meter essential include interior designers, factory and office managers, record and archive keepers, schools, hospitals, laboratories and, of 00 $ course, universities. Silicone Rescue Tape 129 19 95 $ Better, More Technical • 4000 count • Cat III 300V • Dimensions: 170(H) x 78(W) x 48(D) QM-1594 All Savings are based on Original RRP Limited stock on sale items. 199 00 $ Sound Level Datalogger 70 00 $ 129 00 Distance, area, volume or indirect measurement, this does it all in metres, feet or inches. It also adds, subtracts and takes min/max measurements. Invaluable for architects, estimators, builders or renovators. Battery and case included. 25 • Display: 4000 count • Category: Cat IV 600V • Dimensions: 164(L) x 82(W) x 44(D)mm QM-1623 WAS $199.00 Limited Stock • Automatic type identification of Bipolar Junction Transistors (BJTs), Darlington, MOSFETs, JFETs, triacs, thyristors, LEDs, diodes & diode networks • Automatic pinout identification • Gain and leakage current measurement for BJTs • Silicon and germanium detection for BJTs • Forward voltage and test current $ • Dimensions: 100(W) x 71(H) x 27(D)mm QT-2216 Professional Laser Distance Meter • Fixed leads $34 95 • Shockproof SAVE • Case included 00 $ • Auto power-off • Display: 5000 count • Category: Cat II 600V / Cat III 300V • Basic VDC accuracy: 0.500% QM-1544 WAS $59.95 Multifunction Environment Meter with DMM 95 Gaffa tape on steroids. Rescue tape is a self-fusing tape made of the highest quality materials for a permanent airtight and water-tight seal. It is designed for quick plumbing repairs, sealing hoses in your car/truck/boat, coating the ends of rope, wrapping tool handles, emergency o-ring seals or to insulate electrical wiring. Tightly wrap the tape for a quicker bond. Resists fuels, oils, acids, solvents, salt water, road salt, UV rays. NA-2829 Semiconductor Component Analyser Rechargeable Solar DMM Cable Stapling Guns $ • USB interface • Over-range indication • System requirements: Windows 2000, XP, Vista. • Dimensions: 140(L) x 28(W) x 21(H)mm QM-1599 Great gift idea for Father’s Day 15 Piece Micro Driver Set This handy set will fit the bill for all those microscopic fasteners we come across in modern electronics. The handles are colour coded for easy identification and they come in a storage case. The set contains: Slotted: 1mm, 1.4mm, 1.8mm, 2.4mm Phillips: #000, #00, #0, #1 95 $ Torx: T5, T6, T7, T8 Hex: 1.5mm, 2mm, 2.5mm Drivers: 105mm long Case size: 192(L) x 130(W) x 26(H)mm TD-2069 24 To order call 1800 022 888 DON’T JUST DEALS SIT THERE, BUILD SOMETHING TO WARM YOU UP THIS WINTER! Rocker Switches Ergonomic Supercrimp Tool This super heavy-duty ergonomic crimper is designed to perform the same tasks as a normal crimper, but with 40-50% less handleforce required, and a pressure adjustment dial for variable actuation force. It uses interchangeable dies (available separately) that can be quickly and easily changed. Buy only the dies that you require! Dies available for telephone and network plugs, insulation terminals, BNC/TNC connectors to suit RG58/59/62 coax, and even F-type Cat 5 connectors to suit RG59/RG6 coax. TH-1950 $49.95 Dies to suit: 6P6C Telephone Connectors 8P8C Computer Network Connectors Fully Insulated Crimp Terminals BNC/TNC Coax Connectors for RG58/59/62 F-type Cat 5 to suit RG59/6 Non-insulated Crimp Terminals 22-12 AWG SMA/Fibre Optic PV Connectors 49 95 $ TH-1952 TH-1953 TH-1954 TH-1955 TH-1956 TH-1957 TH-1958 TH-1959 $17.95 $17.95 $17.95 $17.95 $17.95 $17.95 $17.95 $29.95 Desoldering Braid Dispenser Gun TH-1952 TH-1958 TH-1956 44 95 • Keyless engine start for track or street. • Illuminated momentary action pushbutton • Rated for 12VDC 50A • Mounting hole 22mm SP-0773 19 95 Limited Stock 19 95 $ IP66 Industrial ABS Enclosures Gasket seals, stainless steel hardware and IP66 rated for use in industrial, marine and other harsh environments. The closures have a locking catch that engages to positively hold the lid closed until disengaged. Each enclosure includes a 1.8mm galvanised chassis for mounting DIN rail, switchgear, relays or circuit breakers. A size for any application. OPAQUE COVER: Small 125(L) x 125(W) x 75(D)mm HB-6400 Was $16.95 Now $11.95 Save $5.00 Medium 175(L) x 125(W) x 75(D)mm HB-6402 Was $29.95 Now $24.95 Save $5.00 Large 200(L) x 200(W) x 130(D)mm HB-6404 Was $34.95 Now $29.95 Save $5.00 TRANSPARENT COVER: Small 125(L) x 75(W) x 75(D)mm HB-6410 Was $18.95 Now $13.95 Save $5.00 Medium 175(L) x 125(W) x 75(D)mm HB-6412 Was $32.95 Now $27.95 Save $5.00 SAVE $$$ FROM 11 95 $ Cat. ST-0581 Cat. ST-0583 Cat. ST-0585 Cat. ST-0586 $4.95 $5.45 $7.95 $7.95 C&K Toggle Switches Quality US C&K toggle switches with solder tags. SPDT Mini Toggle Switch ST-0396 $6.45 SPDT Centre Off Mini Toggle Switch ST-0397 $6.95 DPDT Mini Toggle Switch ST-0398 $8.95 DPDT Centre Off Mini Toggle Switch ST-0399 $9.45 2 Channel USB Oscilloscope Plug 'n Play USB technology means this oscilloscope is easy to setup and use. The included software includes a chart recorder, function generator, logic generator, logic analyser, and spectrum analyser, all in one easy to use package. See website for more. • Oscilloscope, spectrum analyzer • Sample rate: 100 Hz - 200 kHz • Input voltage -20 - +20 V $ 00 • ADC capacity: 10 bits SAVE QC-1930 Was $299 199 $100 00 Great gift idea for Father’s Day www.jaycar.com.au 12 95 $ Also available: 12VDC 20A SPST Illuminated Red Cat. ST-0587 $4.95 SPST momentary action, brass body with large chrome-plated actuator. Can accommodate panel thickness of up to 22mm. Mounting hole 16mm, screw terminals. SP-0701 $ IP65 SPDT Centre Off Rocker Illuminated Switch SPST SPDT DPDT DPDT Centre off SPST Heavy Duty Pushbutton Marine Switch Engine Start Switch 12 95 $ Limited stock on sale items. All Savings are based on Original RRP TOOLS $6.95 $8.95 $6.95 $8.95 • SPST • Illuminated red • Rated for 12VDC 20A • Mounting hole 20.5 x 37mm SK-0997 Rated for 277VAC 20A with 11.5mm Mounting hole. IP65 rated for use in harsh environments. Rated for 14V 10A, with 22mm mounting hole. Only red is illuminated. SP-0756 SP-0757 SP-0758 SP-0759 Illuminated IP56 Rated Rocker Switch Heavy Duty Toggle Switches IP56 Rated Pushbutton Switches Black SPST Momentary Red SPST Momentary Illuminated Black SPST Push-On Push-Off Red SPST Push-On Push-Off Illuminated 4 $ 95 • Rated for 240VAC 10A • Mounting hole 34 x 15mm SK-0993 • On-Off-On • Rating: 14VDC, 21A • Cutout size: 34 x 21mm SK-0999 9 SAVE 35 00 $ Waterproof SPST large rocker actuator for harsh environment applications. IP65 rated, illuminated switch for automotive and marine applications. Illuminates one side red and one side green. Long-lasting heavy duty lubricant grease for bearings, sliding mechanisms, battery terminals, chains, sprockets or other moving parts. White in colour so it forms a kind of thick, milky sea in the lubricated area. Reduce friction, protects against corrosion. $ 95 NA-1015 $ SPST IP56 Rated Rocker Switch IP56 rated, large rocker actuator. Lithium Grease - 400g An integrated desoldering tool for service and production work. Saves time and money by reducing waste. • ESD safe • Safer - no more burned fingers • Replacement braid: NS-3043 $9.95 NS-3042 WAS $79.95 3 4 Wind Generators Always at the forefront of alternative energy technology, we’re pleased to offer this new range of wind turbine generators. As well as the 200W model we now have a super-compact 300W version, and a big 500W unit for those who want to generate some serious power. All models feature external charge controllers with three-phase AC output, so you can install a long cable run without worrying about DC voltage drop. NOTE: All wind generator models are supplied without mounting tower and associated mounting hardware. WARNING: These wind generators are suitable for permanent terrestrial installations ONLY! FROM 200W 12VDC • Number of Blades: 3 $ • Included: generator, blades, tail, hub, nose cone, external charge controller MG-4520 $399.00 399 00 Check out our new 300W Designed to enable the joining of mains 3-core flex cables while providing a robust and waterproof connection. Includes 3-way terminal block, but will also accommodate any connector that fits within the internal dimensions of the housing. • IP68 rated • AS/NZS3100 • Voltage rating: 250VAC • Current rating: 16A max • Accepts cables 6 - 10mm dia PS-4068 POWER 18W 3 - 12VDC with USB Outlet • Dimensions: 69(L) x 39(W) x 31(H)mm Cat. MP-3312 $24.95 29 $ 95 FROM 19 95 $ 12VDC Car Cigarette Lighter Socket 4 Way Splitter 18W 3 - 12VDC with USB Outlet • Dimensions: 69(L) x 39(W) x 31(H)mm Cat. MP-3314 $29.95 With the plethora of 12VDC plug appliances now available, your car's single cigarette lighter socket seems somewhat insufficient. This cigarette socket splitter enables you to power up to four 12VDC plug appliances at once. From our range alone you can plug in a laptop adaptor, a heated travel mug, a sine wave inverter, and a rechargeable LED torch. Plus it features a USB port to charge your iPhone® or other USB gadget. Mounting hardware included. 27W 3 - 12VDC with USB Outlet • 7 output plugs with USB outlet • Dimensions: 96(L) x 50(W) x 30(H)mm Cat. MP-3316 $34.95 25W 9 - 24VDC with USB Outlet • Dimensions: 96(L) x 50(W) x 30(H)mm Cat. MP-3318 $34.95 • 12VDC plug with 12m lead • 4 x 12VDC socket outputs • 1 x 5VDC 1A USB port • 10A max PS-2019 95 $ Limited Stock 19 80W Portable Fold-Up Solar Panel Fold it away in the carry bag when not in use, then when you set up camp just fold it out so your batteries are being charged. A stand is included so you can position the panel for optimum solar capture, and charge controller is fitted to ensure batteries are correctly charged. Excellent for your next camping, 4WD or boating trek. • Rated voltage: 12V Great gift • Voltage at pmax: 17.3V idea for • Current at pmax: 4.64A Father’s Day • Open circuit voltage: 21.5V • Short circuit current: 5.1A • Dimensions: Open: 1090(W) x 623(H) x 36(D)mm Folded: 545(L) x 623(W) x 73(D)mm ZM-9130 Normally $649.00 599 00 $ SAVE 50 $ 00 Better, More Technical SL-2795 SL-2796 SL-2797 SL-2798 $5.95 $5.95 $5.95 $5.95 3 x 1W puck lights that can be surface mounted or recessed to fit into your décor. They're powered by a single plugpack with a distribution block on a 2 metre cable, and each light has its own 600mm cable, so you can easily install them yourself. IP68 3-Core Flex Joiner 7.2W 3 - 12VDC with USB Outlet • Dimensions: 69(L) x 39(W) x 31(H)mm Cat. MP-3310 $19.95 5 Pk 2 $ 95 3 Piece LED Puck Light Kit See our catalogue or 500W 24V website for more details • Number of Blades: 3 • Included: generator, blades, tail, hub, nose cone, charge controller MG-4540 $999.00 These switchmode plugpack adaptors are slim in size, lightweight, and feature manually selectable variable voltage outputs. All are MEPS compliant and come supplied with 7 plugs and a USB output socket. (MP-3318 does not include USB socket) A range of drop-in replacement halogen globes that will fit standard bayonet or Edison screw fittings, use only 2/3 the energy, last for over 1000 hours and, being halogen maintain the same warm quality of light that everyone is used to. Sizes for any room or use: 42W is 60W equivalent Edison Screw 42W is 60W equivalent Bayonet 70W is 100W equivalent Edison Screw 70W is 100W equivalent Bayonet 300W 12VDC MG-4580 $599.00 Lightweight Wind Generators! 300W 24VDC MG-4582 $599.00 Features: moulded, compact, efficient blade design, are lightweight, have neodymium magnets, and the charge controllers are built into the generator heads. • Number of Blades: 3 Spare parts available. • Included: generator, blades, tail, hub, nose cone Switchmode Plugpacks Halogen Replacement Bulbs Special Introductory Price All Savings are based on Original RRP Limited stock on sale items. • Fashionable cool white colour • More than 30,000 hours life • Power supply 12VDC 1A • Light size: 72(Dia) x 28(H)mm ST-3894 149 00 $ Vehicle LED Daytime Running Lights These Euro styled superbright LED bulbs will turn on automatically on ignition, making your car more noticeable on the road. With a lifespan of 50,000 hours, these long life and energy saving DRLs are a much better daytime alternative than using your fog lights or low beam headlights. Flush-mounted brackets are included for easy installation and directional tilt-adjustment. 149 00 $ • Energy efficient 12V 6.1W • Emark 87R certificate • Each lamp measures 190(W) x 30(H) x 43(D)mm SL-3419 IP67 LED Landscape Spotlights IP67 rated for complete protection against the weather and can even be mounted in a water feature or rock pool Being LED, they use very little power and will last for thousands of hours. Each can be mounted on a surface or on the stout spike and thrust into the ground in a convenient location. Each has a 5m length of cable and extension cables are available. 1W or 3W types. • Provides natural-looking light • Energy efficient • Equivalent to a 50 watt halogen FROM 1W IP67 LED Garden Spotlight 3 x 1W IP67 LED Garden Spotlight Power Supply - 12VAC 12W Power Supply - 12VAC 24W Extension Cable - 5m Screw Lock SL-2755 SL-2756 SL-2757 SL-2754 SL-2759 19 95 $ $29.95 $59.95 $24.95 $39.95 $19.95 To order call 1800 022 888 DEALS DON’T JUST SIT THERE, BUILD SOMETHING Most PIRS are generally not suitable for outdoor use. The dual lenses, use of two synchronised PIR sensors and microwave technologies, plus the movement detection algorithm built in reduces false alarms and with the IP65 rating makes this sensor suitable for outdoor security applications. It also has NO and NC alarm outputs, tamper switch and LED alarm trigger indicator. See website for specifications. • All-in-one motion sensor • Automatic background analysis • Selectable PIR and microwave sensitivity • 12VDC power • Dimensions: 168(H) x 95(W) x 65(D)mm LA-5042 Swivel Bracket to suit: LA-5043 $19.95 149 00 $ 12V 100Ah Deep Cycle Gel Battery Deep-cycle gel performance for solar installations and other alternative energy systems. 499 Low Voltage Battery Isolator With microprocessor control, this indispensable device monitors the output voltage of any 12V lead-acid battery. If the terminal voltage drops below 11.9V, the battery will be automatically disconnected. Essential for boats, camping, caravans, RVs, 4WD, solar power systems etc. Gear For The Outdoors Remember putting your keys down but cant quite pinpoint where? This little gadget will help you with your problem in no time. Simply press the colour coded button allocated to your keys on the main unit and the matching receiver will beep so you can find those missing keys. The base unit can be placed on a counter top or be wall mounted. Stand included. 49 95 $ • Transmits radio signal up to 25m away • Key fobs incorporate LED flashlight • Required 3 x AA Batteries XC-0353 Keyring Keyfinder with LED Torch Ever misplaced your keys and needed them in a hurry? This brilliant device will generate a beeping sound when it detects a whistle. It will work effectively within a 3 metre radius. Also doubles as a handy keyring torch! Batteries included. • Uses 2 x LR44 batteries • Size: 52(L) x 40(W) x 15(W)mm XC-0351 4 $ 95 3 Stage 48V 9A Battery Charger Suitable for golf buggies, electric wheelchairs or similar applications. It monitors and manages your charging with three different stages and will maintain the optimum charge level. Compact and lightweight. Includes output cables with eye terminals to attach to your battery. 00 499 $ 99 95 $ • Switchable charging modes • Short circuit, output current, polarity and thermal protection • LED charge status indication Great for Golf • Digital Charge Display • Input: 190 - 260VAC Buggies! • Output: 48VDC <at> 9A max • Dimensions: 298(L) x 112(W) x 60(H)mm MB-3628 Siren to suit Shadow Immobilising Car Alarm • Multi-Tone 20 watt Battery Back-Up Siren with security key shut-off • Shock Sensor (adjustable sensitivity settings) • Bonnet Pin Switch (protects engine bay from tamper) • Supplementary Installation booklet LA-8975 $49.95 • Micro-processor controlled technology • 2 button 2 channel code hopping remotes • External relay output for the third immobilisation point • Panic button personal safety feature • Heavy duty 2 x 40 amp immobiliser relay circuits • Horn or siren output SPECIAL DEAL • Remote central locking Buy Both for (if car fitted with central locking) LA-8970 $139.00 $138.95 & Save $50 www.jaycar.com.au These fantastic X-Glow torches utilise Cree® high performance LEDs, which are renown for providing superior light and longer globe life than other brands. Incredibly energy efficient, Cree® LEDs produce a clear smooth beam of brilliant Save $$$ white light with minimal energy lost through residual heat. These X-Glow torches feature robust water resistant aluminium casings for heavy duty use, and they will even cold start in sub-zero temperatures. 80 Lumens ST-3372 Was $47.95 Now $29.95 Save $18 136 Lumens ST-3374 Was $64.95 Now $34.95 Save $30 176 Lumens ST-3376 Was $69.95 Now $39.95 Save $30 Limited Stock 1 Watt LED Torch with In-built Car Charger Plug Low battery? No worries, this super-bright 1 watt LED torch conveniently recharges in your car's cigarette lighter socket. With a robust aluminium alloy housing it can take a fair amount of abuse and still shine as brightly as the 95 $ day you bought it. • Dimensions: 160(L) x 35(Dia)mm SL-3381 19 SHADOW 3-Point Engine Immobilising Car Alarm Deal This high quality engine immobilising car alarm surpasses the AS/NZS 4601:1999 standard and boasts a range of features including: THIS WINTER! Limited stock on sale items. All Savings are based on Original RRP 190 Lumen CREE® LED Powered Torch with Adjustable Lens With a massive light output of 190 lumens, a tactical switch and multiple light modes every 4WD should have one in the glovebox. Adjustable beam with 5 zoom options. • Requires 3 x AAA batteries ST-3456 39 95 $ Rechargeable Air Pump From party balloons and pool toys to larger air mattresses and rubber dinghies - this high-volume lowpressure rechargeable air pump will have the job done in no time. Recharged via mains power or car charger, its portable cord-free operation makes this a must-have accessory for your beach and camping inflatables. 39 95 $ • Inflation and deflation port • Includes hose and two air nozzle fittings • Mains adaptor (240VAC) and car charger (12VDC) included GH-1119 Electronic Transformers for LED Lights These electronic transformers are designed to be used with LED lighting products that take a 12V power source, for example our LED MR16 replacement globes, and provide the same kind of efficient power delivery and compact size as a normal electronic transformer. They deliver a constant 12VDC and feature short circuit, over temperature, over load and spike protection. 10W and 20W models available: 10 Watt MP-3360 $19.95 20 Watt MP-3362 $24.95 POWER • Capacity: 100Ah • Initial charge current: 30A • Cycle voltage: 14.4 - 15V • Standby voltage: 13.5 - 13.8V • Weight: 31.5kg • Dimensions: 330(L) x 00 $ 173(W) x 223(H) SB-1695 Full range of SLA & GEL batteries in stock - see in store • High cranking capacity - 800A • High input/output current - 200A • Low power consumption - 15mA • 3 year warranty • Mounting hardware included • Dimensions: 85(H) x 55(W) x 35(D)mm MB-3678 TO WARM YOU UP Colour Coded Key Finder Outdoor IP65 Rated Tri-tech Microwave/PIR Sensor 5 6 USB & HARD DISK DRIVE DOCKING STATIONS Dual 2.5/3.5" SATA HDD Docking Station - USB 3.0 4-Port USB 3.0 Hub USB 3.0 hub with four ports. 4.8Gbps data rate. 10X times faster than USB2.0. 79 95 79 95 $ • Compatible with Windows XP/Vista/7/Mac 9.X and higher • Dimensions: 145(L) x 94(W) x 82(H)mm XC-4696 Note: hard drive not included 99 00 $ • Dimensions: 130(W) x 61(H) x 103(D)mm XC-4697 Note: hard drive not included • Dimensions: 85(L) x 32(W) x 18(H)mm XC-4947 Due late August 600VA 375W Line Interactive UPS Compact and completely self-contained, this is the ideal backup solution for your data or other important equipment. It has 3 surge-protected outlets as well as 3 outlets backed up by the UPS. It also has RJ11 ports for protecting phone or fax lines. COMPUTERS A 2.5"/3.5" SATA dock for USB 3.0 enabled desktop PCs and laptops. USB 3.0 boasts theoretical speeds of up to 4.8Gbps, that's ten times faster than its USB 2.0 predecessor. This dock is particularly useful for computer technicians, IT professionals and those of you who download a lot and need to swap between drives frequently. A blazing fast USB 3.0 ready dual SATA docking station for the home or office. Dock two 3.5 or 2.5 inch SATA drives or one of each, and in a flash you can back up gigabytes, terabytes or petabytes of information without the hassle of installing hard drives in enclosures or in the PC. $ • Cold start feature • Software included • Rating: 375W, 600VA • SLA battery: 7Ah • Supply voltage 220 to 280VAC • Backup time: 3 min at full load • Recharge time: 10 hrs • Output waveform: Step sine wave • Dimensions: 268(L) x 180(W) x 80(H)mm MP-5222 Ethernet over Power - 200Mbps If you don't have the time for crimping cables and installing wallplates, Ethernet over the existing power cables is a great solution. The will convert Ethernet packets from the Ethernet port to powerline communication packets (PLC packets), which run on regular home power lines, then converts them from PLC packets back to Ethernet packets. A simple $179 00 way to extend speedy wired networking around the house. SAVE • Data rate: Up to 200Mbps • Data link protocol: HomePlug AV YN-8350 WAS $189.00 119 00 $ 10 00 $ High Quality USB 2.0 Leads - 2.0m High quality USB 2.0 leads for your PC peripherals, professional audio or camera equipment. Superior shielding protects against potential electromagnetic interferences and ensures data continuity. 20 $14.95 $14.95 $14.95 $14.95 2.5" SATA HDD Enclosure - USB 3.0 High Quality IEEE1394 Cables - 1.8m Take advantage of the massive speed increase of USB 3.0. Slot your 2.5" SATA HDD into this enclosure and when connected to a USB 3.0 port of a computer you will experience speeds up to 10 times faster than USB 2.0. This range of high quality IEEE1394 cables boast 24K gold plated connectors, 99.9% oxygen free copper conductors and are shielded against EMI. Ideal to obtain faultless data streams. • Includes one 1.1m USB 3.0 Micro B to Male A cable • Locking screws included • Dimensions: 77(W) x 113(L) x 14(D)mm XC-4684 B 9-pin to B 9-pin Cable B 9-pin to A 4-pin Cable B 9-pin to A 6-pin Cable WC-7630 $19.95 WC-7632 $19.95 WC-7634 $19.95 USB 3.0 Adaptors Plug B to Socket A Adaptor PA-0930 $12.95 Micro B Plug to Socket A Adaptor PA-0931 $12.95 Socket A to Socket A Gender Changer PA-0932 $12.95 Plug Micro B to Socket B Adaptor PA-0933 $12.95 Better, More Technical Ultra-compact unobtrusive indoor antenna for wireless networking at home or in a small office. Termination is by SMA connector on 1m lead. 29 All Savings are based on Original RRP Limited stock on sale items. 59 95 $ 2.4GHz Wi Fi Yagi Antenna • Frequency range: 2.4 -2.4835GHz • VSWR: ≤ 2.0 • Impedance: 50 ohm 95 $ • Gain: 8dBi • Polarisation: Vertical • Base: 85(L) x 47(W)mm AR-3282 Dustproof & waterproof to IP68, so if it should ever get dirty simply wipe clean with a sponge. Perfect for industrial, food & beverage, laboratories, garages and even outdoor use. It also comes with a silicone sleeve for added protection. Antibacterial rubber construction. • Full-sized QWERTY layout 00 $ • USB connectivity SAVE • Windows 2000/XP/Vista 00 $ • Measures 440(L) x 138(W) x 12(H)mm XC-5141 WAS $99.00 65 3 Port Motorised Retracting USB Hub 5 Port 100/1000 N-Way Gigabit Switch 59 WC-7790 WC-7792 WC-7794 WC-7796 Industrial IP68 USB Keyboard 34 A high performance switch that offers a cost-effective means of increasing network performance and reducing congestion. It manages the transmission of data packets on the network & enables simultaneous connections between several machines without interfering with data being exchanged on the other connections. 9VAC power pack included. 95 $ • Standards compliance: IEEE 802.3, IEEE 802.3u, & IEEE 802.3ab SAVE • Size: 130(W) x 103(D) x 27(H)mm 00 $ YN-8089 WAS $79.95 Limited Stock New USB Leads USB A (male) to USB B (male) USB A (male) to USB-Mini B (male) USB A (male) to USB A (male) USB A (male) to USB-Micro B (male) USB 3.0 SATA 2.5"/3.5" HDD Dock Just touch the top and your USB hub will rise from the surface of your desk to do your bidding. Touch it again and it lowers itself back into place and out of the way. It has 3 USB 2.0 ports and also acts as a cable grommet to keep all your computer cables neat and tidy. • Powered by USB • Mounting hole: 75mm • Mounting depth: 70mm • Diameter: 92mm XC-4877 WAS $14.95 12 95 $ SAVE 2 $ 00 5.5" Graphics Tablet Using a graphics tablet is completely natural, more comfortable and far more accurate than a mouse, with higher resolution and pressure sensitivity. The pen has user defined buttons and "hotspots" around the border of the tablet. Paint, draw, write or touch up. Absolutely essential tool for graphics designers, photographers or other creatives. 69 95 $ • Battery & software included • Windows 2000, XP, Vista or Mac • Dimensions: 205(W) x 190(H)mm XC-0356 USB Powered Extension Lead with 4 Port Hub Extend your printer or any other USB device as far as 10 metres away from your PC. A 4-port hub adds extra flexibility. Powered by USB from the host computer. 95 $ XC-4122 49 To order call 1800 022 888 DON’T JUST DEALS SIT THERE, BUILD SOMETHING 2 Channel Pro DJ Mixer The ideal mixer to learn on. Two channels each with RCA inputs for CD or other line level source and a set of dedicated phono inputs. The BPM counter is capable of accurately measuring the beats per minute of almost any kind of dance music automatically and works equally well with a CD player or a turntable. 149 00 $ • Level meters on each channel • 2 band EQ on each channel • Phono and line level inputs • Mic and headphone outputs • Effects loop • Line level preamp outputs • Selectable CF curve • Dimensions: 330(W) x 22(H) x 102(D)mm AM-4206 THIS WINTER! LED DMX Spotlights Suitable for professional and stage use, this UHF diversity wireless microphone system features 16 user-selectable channels with easy infra-red pairing on each microphone provide interference-free transmission. It also has phase locked loop (PLL) circuitry for frequency stability. The system includes 2 microphones with batteries and receiver unit in 19" rackmount chassis. See website for full specifications. 499 $ 00 299 $ 00 2.1mm Illuminated Polarity Sensing DC Connectors Simplifies installation of CCTV cameras, access control and other security applications. These 2.1mm DC connectors detect and indicate the polarity of power connections with integrated LEDs. They also shine brighter as voltage increases. 5-30 VAC/VDC range, 1 metre lead length. Available in two models: DC Plug WQ-7288 $4.95 DC Socket WQ-7289 $4.95 Battery Powered 2.4GHz AV Sender 26 95 $ 00 6.5mm Mono to Speakon Cable 3m Stage quality 6.5mm mono to Speakon cable for connecting small PA systems. 3m, super flexi cable. WA-7108 95 $ 16 Dual Siren Personal Alarm with LED Torch Deter thieves and attackers with its loud dual 130dB sirens and powerful independent torch function which will strobe when the alarm is activated. Simply pull the rip-cord to pull out the pin. Fantastic for travellers. • Includes 4 x LR44 batteries • Dimensions: 105(L) x 28(W) x 15(H)mm LA-5181 Also available Personal Mini Alarm $ with LED Torch LA-5183 $9.95 14 95 Colour Dome Camera Kit with 2 Wire Connection A simple 2 wire combined arrangement for power and video make this system a snap to install. The system uses a CMOS image sensor with 350TV line resolution and will automatically sense signal cable tampering or incorrect wiring and alert you with a warning signal. Kit includes camera, signal processor, connecting cable, and mains adaptor. 00 QC-3264 WAS $129.00 $ • Outdoor IR version (IP56 rated) also available - QC-3266 $89.00 SAVE $ 00 • Gold plated terminals • Mounting brackets and hardware included • Digital voltage display $ • Dimensions: 260(H) x 75(Dia)mm RU-6754 Budget 4 Channel DVR with 4 Cameras This is an excellent DVR that is ideally suited to smaller surveillance installations around the home or office. It uses MJPEG video compression and can store over 150 hours of video on its 250Gb hard drive. Recording setup is simple and various trigger modes can be set across the day including include timer recording, motion detection, and manual operation. Supplied with 4 x weather resistant colour day/night cameras, connecting leads and wireless remote. • 4 x colour camera inputs • 1 x composite video output • Frame rate 25fps (Quad mode) QV-3063 Was $599 Dimensions: 105(L) x 85(W) x 55(H)mm QV-3095 WAS $349.00 Limited Stock Limited stock on sale items. All Savings are based on Original RRP 499 00 $ SAVE 100 00 $ Quad Processor with 2 CMOS Colour Cameras & Remote Control Add a monitor or plug into your TV and you have a complete surveillance system. With 2 colour IR cameras, this processor turns any standard TV or monitor into a mulitplexer. It can display a single camera view, or multiple combinations of different camera views including one or two picture-in-picture or automatic sequencing. 69 60 www.jaycar.com.au High farad capacitors act as surge current reservoirs for your amplifiers and other electrical equipment. Integrate these capacitors into your audio system to avoid voltage drops from high transient current peaks. 99 00 SAVE 53 $ Par 64 5 Channel 94 LED DMX Spotlight SL-3424 $169.00 • Dimensions: 245(L) x 195(Dia)mm 1 Farad Capacitor Provides hassle-free sharing of Audio and Video signals all over your house, office, or shop where power and space are a consideration. Wireless and compact, both transmitter and receiver operate on battery power. Connection to the AV source is via 3.5mm to RCA composite video and audio lead. • 2 x 1m leads included • Each unit requires 2 x AA batteries • 85mm wide AR-1852 Was $79.95 Budget 61 LED 4 Chanel DMX Spotlight SL-3420 $99.00 • Dimensions: 180(L) x 170(Dia)mm SIGHT & SOUND & SECURITY The ideal small mixer for home recording, small PA systems etc. This is a well-featured little unit with high and low mic inputs, separate EQ, gain and pan controls, aux send and return for effects, recording outputs and phantom power. Team any of these LED DMX-controlled lights with a controller or software for complete control over your stage, party or DJ lighting setup. Each is 240V powered, individually addressable via DIP switch and includes a mounting bracket. All Aluminium Par 46 5 Channel 94 LED DMX Spotlight SL-3422 $139.00 • Dimensions: 300(L) x 135(Dia)mm Also available: UHF 2 Channel Wireless Microphone AM-4122 $269.00 8 Channel Compact Mixing Console with Digital Effects • Four mono channels with high & low impedance inputs • 2-band EQ on all mono channels • Gain, aux send and pan controls • 2 stereo channels • Phantom power (48V) • Headphone output • Dimensions: 270(W) x 270(H) x 50(D)mm AM-4204 Limited Stock TO WARM YOU UP Dual Channel UHF Wireless Microphone • Power: 12 - 18VDC • Dimensions: 420(L) x 210(W) x 45(H)mm AM-4120 7 149 00 SAVE $200 00 $ Anatomy Models Perfect For Schools and Universities 4D Human Skin Model 1:1 Scale Human Heart Model 4D Human Head Model Perfect skin section model up to medical educational level. Includes removable hair and skin layers with extra acne parts. A fantastic educational tool for schools and medical practices. Deluxe cutaway life-size heart anatomy model that's perfect for medical educational purposes. Includes detachable tricuspid valve and mitral valve as well as detailed parts of the aorta, pulmonary artery, superior vena cave, inferior vena cave and septum. 95 $ • Display stand included • Approx 185mm high GG-2378 Note: All recommended for ages 8+ Learn all about how the brain works and the structure of the skull. A fantastic cutaway model for education in medical practices and schools. • 25 pieces included • Approx 200mm high GG-2377 49 24 95 $ Take a few frosty ones to the cricket - or a bottle of chardonnay if you like to bowl from the Paddington end. Lined with insulation and holds a 6-pack. 2 $ 95 1:10 Scale Remote Control Brushless Electric Cars Brushless Touring • Length: 360mm • Wheelbase: 260mm • Track: 200mm • Gear ratio: 6.25:1 • Battery: 7.2V, 2000mAh GT-3674 Was $299.00 269 00 $ Truggy • Length: 460mm • Wheelbase: 275mm • Track: 250mm • Gear ratio: 1:8.038 • Battery: 7.2V, 2000mAh • Recommended for ages 12+ GT-3676 Was $329.00 • Requires 4 x AA batteries • Camera driver software and USB cable included • Windows 2000, XP & $ Vista compatible • Suitable for ages 3+ QC-3188 19 95 $ 49 95 Equipped with a robotic arm and an enhanced high-speed program, it can teach you to play as well as improve your skills. • Suitable for novice to experienced players • 128 levels including training, tournament & problem solving levels up to mate-in-6 moves $229 00 • Programmed in accordance with the International SAVE Chess Rules 00 $ • Board size: 380(W) x 380(D) x 40(H)mm GT-3516 WAS $299.00 Limited Stock 70 SAVE 30 $ The kids will enjoy hours of creativity with this digital photo & video camera. The robust design can withstand heavy duty play. It has a 16MB internal memory and can capture up to 120 still photos or up to 50 seconds of video. 2Robot Chess Board Featuring a much higher motor speed than your average RC car (3300 rpm/Volt), these brushless electric cars are more efficient, so your battery pack lasts longer. Both models are ready to race and have high-efficiency brushless motors with electronic speed controllers, four wheel drive, independent suspension, super-tuff Lexan bodies, rechargeable batterypacks and digital proportional remote control units. 00 Great Gift Idea For Father’s Day Spare parts available separately YOUR LOCAL JAYCAR STORE Australia Freecall Orders: Ph 1800 022 888 AUSTRALIAN CAPITAL TERRITORY Belconnen Ph (02) 6253 5700 Fyshwick Ph (02) 6239 1801 NEW SOUTH WALES Albury Ph (02) 6021 6788 Alexandria Ph (02) 9699 4699 Bankstown Ph (02) 9709 2822 Blacktown Ph (02) 9678 9669 Bondi Junction Ph (02) 9369 3899 Brookvale Ph (02) 9905 4130 Campbelltown Ph (02) 4620 7155 Coffs Harbour Ph (02) 6651 5238 Croydon Ph (02) 9799 0402 Erina Ph (02) 4365 3433 Gore Hill Ph (02) 9439 4799 Hornsby Ph (02) 9476 6221 Liverpool Ph (02) 9821 3100 Maitland Ph (02) 4934 4911 279 00 $ SAVE 50 $ 00 24 95 $ Kid's Digital Photo & Video Camera Pack one of these for the next trip and avoid nasty surprises at the check-in counter. • Requires 2 x AAA batteries • Capacity: 40kg • Tare and auto-off • Backlit LCD • Overload and low battery indication • Size: 122(L) x 85(H) x 25(W)mm QM-7232 Female reproductive system model for education and medical study. Includes detachable organs with cross section parts and internal details. • 16 parts with stand and assembly guide • Approx 240mm high GG-2388 24 95 Digital Luggage Scale Jaycar Cooler Bag • Size: 260(W) x 260(H) x 120(D)mm HB-5005 • 14 pieces included • Display stand included • Approx 185mm high $ GG-2379 4D Female Reproductive System Model Power Microscope Kit With reflecting and transmission light, this power microscope will enable you to see the closest details under a monocular eyepiece or projection screen. Easy to assemble and comes with a ready made specimen for immediate exploration of the microscopic world. Requires 2 x AA batteries. See website for full kit contents. • Dimensions: 95(L) x 163(H) x 75(W)mm • Power 50X-100X, 150X-300X, 95 $ 300X-600X microscope QC-3243 29 Mini PC/MP3 Speakers USB Cassette Deck Record cassette tracks to your computer via USB or play back through the built-in 5W speaker. You can also run the line level outputs to an external amplifier and use it as a component cassette deck. Plug in your MP3 player or any other audio source and the 30mm speakers will provide more than enough volume to bop along to. Powered by batteries or 6VDC plugpack (not included). Dimensions: 178(L) x 72(H) x 178(W)mm GE-4054 • Requires 4 x AAA batteries • Dimensions: 167(W) x 54(H) x 32(D)mm XC-5177 Newcastle Ph (02) 4965 3799 Penrith Ph (02) 4721 8337 Rydalmere Ph (02) 8832 3120 Sydney City Ph (02) 9267 1614 Taren Point Ph (02) 9531 7033 Tweed Heads Ph (07) 5524 6566 Wollongong Ph (02) 4226 7089 NORTHERN TERRITORY Darwin Ph (08) 8948 4043 QUEENSLAND Aspley Ph (07) 3863 0099 Caboolture Ph (07) 5432 3152 Cairns Ph (07) 4041 6747 Capalaba Ph (07) 3245 2014 Ipswich Ph (07) 3282 5800 Labrador Ph (07) 5537 4295 Mackay Ph (07) 4953 0611 Maroochydore Ph (07) 5479 3511 Mermaid Beach Ph (07) 5526 6722 Nth Rockhampton Ph (07) 4926 4155 Arrival dates of new products in this flyer were confirmed at the time of print. Occasionally these dates change unexpectedly. Please ring your local store to check stock details. Prices valid to 23rd August 2010. All savings are based on original RRP 79 95 $ Townsville Underwood Woolloongabba SOUTH AUSTRALIA Adelaide Clovelly Park Gepps Cross TASMANIA Hobart Launceston VICTORIA Cheltenham Coburg Frankston Geelong Hallam Melbourne Ringwood Shepparton Springvale Sunshine Ph (07) 4772 5022 Ph (07) 3841 4888 Ph (07) 3393 0777 Ph (08) 8231 7355 Ph (08) 8276 6901 Ph (08) 8262 3200 Ph (03) 6272 9955 Ph (03) 6334 2777 Ph (03) 9585 5011 Ph (03) 9384 1811 Ph (03) 9781 4100 Ph (03) 5221 5800 Ph (03) 9796 4577 Ph (03) 9663 2030 Ph (03) 9870 9053 Ph (03) 5822 4037 Ph (03) 9547 1022 Ph (03) 9310 8066 Head Office 320 Victoria Road, Rydalmere NSW 2116 Ph: (02) 8832 3100 Fax: (02) 8832 3169 Thomastown Werribee WESTERN AUSTRALIA Maddington Midland Northbridge Rockingham NEW ZEALAND Christchurch Dunedin Glenfield Hamilton Hastings Manukau Mt Wellington Newmarket New Lynn Palmerston Nth Wellington NZ Freecall Orders Online Orders Website: www.jaycar.com.au Email: techstore<at>jaycar.com.au 14 95 $ Ph (03) 9465 3333 Ph (03) 9741 8951 Ph (08) 9493 4300 Ph (08) 9250 8200 Ph (08) 9328 8252 Ph (08) 9592 8000 Ph (03) 379 1662 Ph (03) 471 7934 Ph (09) 444 4628 Ph (07) 846 0177 Ph (06) 876 0239 Ph (09) 263 6241 Ph (09) 258 5207 Ph (09) 377 6421 Ph (09) 828 8096 Ph (06) 353 8246 Ph (04) 801 9005 Ph 0800 452 922 PRODUCT SHOWCASE “Environment” multimeter does light, sound, temperature, humidity, frequency . . . etc! The new Digitech QM1594 Multimeter from Jaycar Electronics does much more than measure your usual voltages, currents, resistance, etc. Dubbed a “multifunction environment meter” this versatile meter may be the only one you will ever need as it also handles light levels to 40,000 Lux, sound levels from 35 to 100dB (C weighted, 30-10kHz), frequency (5Hz-10MHz), temperature 0 to 50°C (or with supplied K-type temperature probe -20 to 1300°C), relative humidity 33-99% . . . along with the more “usual” ranges of AC/DC voltage, AC/ DC current (including A ranges), resistance, capacitance, diode check, etc. Priced at $129, it is supplied with the test leads shown at right (including thermocouple), 9V battery and instruction manual. It’s available now from all Jaycar Electronics stores, resellers and the web Techstore. Stomp Boxes: Designed to handle it! Hammond Electronics’ new 1590 STOMP die-cast aluminium enclosures are the housings of choice for leading stomp box manufacturers. Stomp boxes, also known as guitar effect pedals, are used by electric guitarists to produce preset effects such as distortion, wah-wah, delay, chorus and phaser. The 1590 STOMP boxes are a rugged, easy-to-machine die-cast aluminium enclosure well able to cope with the demanding on-stage environment in which they will be used. Available in two sizes, 112 x 60 x 27mm and 119 x 94 x 34mm and a variety of vibrant, bright colours: blue, green, orange, light grey and red. Contact: Hammond Electronics Pty Ltd 11-13 Port Rd, Queenstown, SA 5014 Tel: (08) 8240 2244 Fax: (08) 8240 2255 Website: www.hammondmfg.com siliconchip.com.au Contact: Jaycar Electronics (All stores and web Techstore) Tel: 1800 022 888 Website: www.jaycar.com.au Keystone Components Mini Catalog More than 125 new products for use with SMT or THM applications are featured in this 16-page mini catalog from Keystone Electronics. Products include an expanded selection of battery hardware; contacts, clips, holders and retainers for coin cell and button cells batteries; new, multi-use fuse holders and clips for mini and standard auto blade fuses; top quality, insulated terminals, pins and jacks with PTFE bushings and insulators; standard USB, micro USB, mini USB Type A and B plugs and sockets for both SMT and THM mounting in USB 2.0 and USB 3.0 configurations. New BlueSIM phone combats mobile phone radiation        A recent study by the      International Agency      for Research on Cancer (IARC) has found that people who talk on their mobile phones for 30 minutes a day are up to 40% more likely to develop glioma, a common type of brain cancer. The BlueSIM phone takes the mobile phone away from your head. Developed by an Australian company, the BlueSIM phone works with any Bluetooth-enabled mobile phone (including smart phones). Once the Bluetooth signal of a mobile phone is recognised by the BlueSIM handset, the quick link process begins and use of the BlueSIM handset can commence. From this point forward the mobile phone is recognised as a paired device with the BlueSIM handset, allowing calls to be made to and from the BlueSIM handset via the mobile phone connection. In this regard, the BlueSIM phone becomes an extension of a mobile phone. The BlueSIM phone is available in selected stores throughout Australia and has a recommended retail price of $299.00 Contact: Contact: 10 Gray St, Kilkenny, SA 5009 Tel: (08) 8263 2733 Fax: (08) 8268 1455 Website: www.npa.com.au Tel: 02 9756 6224 Fax: 02 9756 6242 Website: www.bluesim.com.au NPA Pty Ltd The Dualsim Phone Company August 2010  57 By JOHN CLARKE Most readers would know that you can obtain small ultrasonic cleaners for jewellery and similar small items. So why not a much larger version? It would be great for cleaning automotive and other mechanical parts, fabrics which cannot be machine washed, ornate bric-a-brac and a host of other hard-to-clean items. A nyone who has ever needed to clean the parts for a carburettor, differential, gearbox or any other greasy and intricate parts must have often wished for an easier way. Generally you dunk the parts in a container of kerosene, dieseline detergent or whatever, to soak for a while and then you return to the task with various brushes and implements to scrape off the grease and other gunk. It is a dirty and tedious task. But what if you could dispense with all that brushing and scraping? If you could just drop the components in a tank of suitable solvent, press a button and then come back later to remove the parts in sparkling clean condition? Our ultrasonic cleaner is designed to do exactly that job. It uses a high power piezoelectric transducer and an ultrasonic driver to literally blast away the dirt and grime with ultrasonic energy. The solvent might be kerosene or hot water and a wetting agent such as a detergent. At low drive levels the solvent conducts the ultrasonic signal throughout the bath. At higher power levels, the ultrasonic wavefront causes cavitation which causes bubbles to form and then collapse. This is shown in Fig.1. As the wavefront passes, normal pressure is restored and the bubble collapses to produce a shock wave. This shock wave helps to loosen particles from the item being cleaned. The size of the bubbles is dependent upon the ultrasonic frequency and is The two “halves” of the project: the controller at left and the ultrasonic transducer, potted in a length of pipe, at right. 58  Silicon Chip siliconchip.com.au Feature s • 12V plugpac k powered • Automatic timeout • Adjustable timeout • Start butto n • Rugged tran sducer Cleaning a coffee-stained stainless steel tray in our “bath” (actually an old plastic cistern – see page 65). You can’t see the bubbles being generated in this photo – they’re too small – but they are certainly there. WARNING! This circuit produces an output voltage of up to 800V peak-peak to drive the ultrasonic transducer and is capable of delivering a severe (or even FATAL) electric shock. DO NOT touch the output terminals at CON2, the PC tracks leading to CON2 or the transducer terminals when power is applied. To ensure safety, the PC board must be housed in the recommended plastic case, while the transducer must be correctly housed and fully encapsulated in resin as described in the article. smaller with higher frequencies. Industrial ultrasonic cleaners tend to use frequencies between 20kHz and 50kHz while cleaners for small parts typically use frequencies above 50kHz. Our ultrasonic cleaner sweeps the frequency range from about 19kHz to 42kHz to produce cavitation bubbles of varying sizes. The frequency is varied with an irregular pattern to avoid a constant low frequency sub-harmonic in the cleaning bath or tank. Variation of the sub-harmonic frequency reduces the impact of resonances in small items being cleaned that may otherwise cause them to disintegrate. siliconchip.com.au This variation in frequency also prevents standing waves in the cleaning bath that can produce cavitation in one area but no cavitation in another area. This can lead to irregular cleaning action of a component. Actual power delivered is dependent upon the resonant frequency of the piezo transducer. For the Silicon Chip Ultrasonic Cleaner, maximum power delivered by the transducer is at about 40kHz which is the resonant frequency of the specified piezo ultrasonic transducer. The Ultrasonic Cleaner can be set to run for between 30 seconds and 10 minutes. Alternative sweep pattern An alternative sweep pattern is available that sweeps over a frequency range of around 12kHz, centred on the 40kHz resonance. This produces a higher agitation level in the cleaning bath due to the transducer frequently running through its resonance. This alternative sweep pattern should be for intermittent use only. Which sweep pattern is best depends on the component being cleaned and the type of contamination. The driver for our Ultrasonic Cleaner is housed in a small plastic case. This connects to the piezoelectric ultrasonic transducer itself using a length of sheathed 2-core mains-rated CAVITATION BUBBLE FORMS BUBBLE GROWS IN RAREFIED PRESSURE BUBBLE SHRINKS UNDER RESTORED PRESSURE BUBBLE COLLAPSES CAUSING SHOCK WAVES NEW CAVITATION BUBBLE FORMS Fig.1: the ultrasonic cleaning process. It’s all about causing shock FIG.1 solvent to waves in the cleaning literally “shake off” the dirt and grime. You can do this manually – but the ultrasonic transducer does it 40,000 times each second! cable. The piezoelectric transducer is housed in a PVC fitting that covers and insulates the terminals from accidental contact. This is necessary because the transducer is driven at a high voltage which could cause a nasty shock if you come into contact with it. August 2010  59 12V DC INPUT S2 + F1 3A (OPTIONAL) – 2x 4700 F 16V LOW ESR 100 CON1 A D3 1N4004 WARNING! 2.2k 2.2k A POWER LED1 REG1 78L05 K GND 100 F 16V LED2 100 F 16V D7 A  K +5V OUT IN K RUNNING A  K 100nF A A D6 D5 K K 1 Vdd TIMER VR1 10k LIN 5 100nF GP1 2 X1 20MHz 22pF 3 OUT 22pF 22k K A A D1 ZD1 5.1V 1W IC1 PIC12F675I/P A GP0 10k 4 F1 T1 F3 S2 ZD2 5.1V 1W Vss K Q2 RFP30NS 06LE 78L05 LEDS GND K A A IN OUT 8 A 2010 TO ULTRASONIC TRANSDUCER D G ZD1, ZD2 SC  CON3 S3 S1 F2 A 10 7 GP3 10 F 16V G K Q1 RFP30NS 06LE FTD29 FERRITE TRANSFORMER D4 CON2 D 10 6 IN K START S1 K D2 AN2 The output from this Ultrasonic Cleaner driver circuit is at a high voltage (up to 900V p-p). Avoid making contact with the output terminals (CON3) and the transducer terminals when the unit is running or you may experience a severe electric shock. The transducer must be fully encapsulated to ensure safety. ULTRASONIC CLEANER K D4-D7: 1N4148 A K RFP30N06LE D1,D2: 1N5819 D3: 1N4004 A K G D D S Fig.2: the driver circuit for the piezoelectric ultrasonic transducer is controlled by a PIC12F675-I/P micro. Two oscillation modes are available, the alternative is selected by holding the “start” button down as power is applied. The piezo transducer and housing can be directly immersed in the ultrasonic bath or tank. Alternatively the transducer can be glued to the outside of the bath using epoxy resin for deeper baths. in small increments amounting to 320Hz at around 40kHz. Outputs GP0 and GP1 provide complementary gate drive signals for Mosfets Q1 & Q2. Since these outputs only swing from 0V to 5V, Q1 & Q2 are logic-level Mosfets. Standard Mosfets require gate signals of at least 10V for full conduction but logic-level Mosfets will fully conduct with much less. For the RFP30N06LE Mosfets specified, the on-resistance between drain and source is a mere 75mΩ at 20A at a gate voltage of 3V. The on resistance drops further to around 23mΩ at 20A at the higher gate voltage of 4.5V. The Mosfets are rated at 30A continuous. Q1 & Q2 are driven alternately Circuit details and these in turn drive the separate The circuit of our Ultrasonic Cleaner halves of the transformer primary (fig.2) is relatively simple due to the which has its centre tap connected to use of an 8-pin PIC12F675-I/P microthe +12V supply. When Mosfet Q1 is controller, IC1. This drives switched on, current flows in the piezoelectric transducer its section of the transformer via two Mosfets, Q1 & Q2 and primary winding. transformer, T1. The micro- Power Requirements............... 12V at 2.5A Q1 remains on for less than controller also provides the Transducer voltage................. 250VAC square wave 50us depending on the fretimer and the start functions. Frequency range.................... Main mode is 19kHz to 42kHz quency and is then switched Crystal X1 sets the microoff. Both Mosfets are then off with irregular variation controller to run at 20MHz. for a few microseconds before This frequency allows the Alternative frequency Range...... 34 to 44kHz Q2 is switched on. Q2 is then ultrasonic drive to be shifted Timeout Adjustment................ 30s to 10m switched on for the same du- Specifications 60  Silicon Chip siliconchip.com.au Running indication LED2 indicates when the Mosfets are switching on and off. When Q1 is switched on, diode D6 can power LED2 via the 2.2kΩ resistor from the 12V supply. When Q2 is switched on the LED is driven via D5. When both Q1 and Q2 are off, the LED is not driven. When either Q1 or Q2 are switched off, the high voltage from the transformer primary winding at the Mosfets’ drain can couple through diodes D5 or D6 due to capacitance. Diode D7 clamps the voltage to 0.7V above the 12V supply to protect LED2. OPTIONAL SWITCH S2 (CUT TRACK UNDERNEATH IF USED) 100 5819 100nF D2 22k 5819 D1 S1 F2 Q2 S3 F3 5V1 10150140 F1 100nF 22pF 22pF X1 RE NAEL C CI N OSARTLU START S1 CON3 S2 ZD1 10 IC1 12F675 10k 4148 10 F 2.2k T1 Q1 CON2 LED1 A ZD2 A 4700 F 16V LOW ESR E GATL OV H GI H !RE G NAD 100 F 2.2k REG1 4700 F 16V LOW ESR 5V1 4148 10 D5 LED2 4148 D6 4148 100 F CON1 D7 D3 12V DC IN F1 D4 ration as for Q1 and then both Mosfets remain off for a few microseconds before Q1 is switched on again. The gap when both Mosfets are off is the “dead time” and it allows each Mosfet to fully switch off before the other is switched on. The alternate switching action of the Mosfets generates an AC square wave in the secondary and since the primary/secondary turns ratio is 11.25:1, the secondary winding delivers about 250VAC to the piezoelectric transducer at between 19kHz and 42kHz. Mosfets Q1 and Q2 include overvoltage protection which clamp any drain voltage that exceeds 60V. This clamping is required since a high-voltage transient occurs when the transformer primary winding is switched off. Protection for the gate of each Mosfet is provided using 5.1V zener diodes. Although the Mosfet gate is only driven from a 5V signal, the high transient voltage at the drain can be coupled into the gate via capacitance between gate and drain. The 5.1V zener diodes prevent a higher voltage driving IC1’s GP0 and GP1 inputs which could damage them. Further protection is provided for GP0 and GP1 using diodes D1 and D2, which are in parallel with the chip’s internal protection diodes. These clamp and carry the current if the voltage at these pins goes above about 5.3V. TIMER VR1 TO ULTRASONIC TRANSDUCER Fig.3: component overlay for the Ultrasonic Cleaner. All components (except the start button, timer pot and transducer!) are mounted on a single-sided PC board. If an on/off switch is required, the copper track must be cut between the S2 pins. digital value which is used as a basis for the timeout. The maximum timeout of 10 minutes is set with the wiper of VR1 at 5V, with shorter timeouts as VR1 is reduced. The lowest practical setting is about 30s. When the potentiometer is set to its minimum position, the timer will not run and the Mosfets are kept off. If the potentiometer is rotated to this minimum position during the running of the timer, the timer will also be switched off, turning off the Mosfets. Starting the ultrasonic drive is initiated by pressing the start switch. Normally, the GP3 input (pin 4) is held at 5V via a 22kΩ pull up resistor. When the switch is pressed, this input is pulled to 0V and signals IC1 to run the ultrasonic drive. Timer IC1 also performs the timer function. This switches off all drive to the Mosfets after a preset time period, set by the position of potentiometer VR1. VR1 is wired across the 5V supply with the voltage at the wiper monitored by IC1 at the AN2 (pin 5) input. IC1 converts the voltage into a siliconchip.com.au The completed PC board, ready for insertion into the case. The on-board power switch (S2) is not used here – the two PC pin holes (top left) are empty and the thin copper track underneath is intact. August 2010  61 The voltage waveform appearing the ultrasonic transducer as it is swept over a range of frequencies. In this case it is shown at 20.8kHz. Note the high peak-peak voltage of 600V. When S1 is released, the 10µF capacitor across the switch charges up to 5V via the 22kΩ resistor. Diode D4 discharges the capacitor when power is switched off and the 5V supply rail drops to 0V. 5V power for IC1 is derived from the 12V supply via a 100Ω resistor, reverse polarity protection diode D3 and 5V regulator, REG1. The supply to REG1 is filtered with a 100µF capacitor, while the 5V output is bypassed using 100nF and 100µF capacitors. Reverse polarity protection for the power section of the circuit is via a 3A fuse (F1), along with the integral reverse diode within each of Mosfets. These diodes conduct current through the primary windings of transformer T1, effectively clamping the supply voltage at -0.7V, protecting the 4700µF electrolytic capacitors from excessive reverse voltage. The 12V 2.5A plugpack includes foldback current limiting where current at voltage below 12V is reduced from its maximum rating of 2.5A. With a short circuit the current limit is around 0.5A. The fuse is unlikely to blow and power dissipation in the Mosfets is around 0.35W total. This does not cause any harm to the Mosfets, the transformer or the capacitors. The fuse is included to prevent the PC board tracks from fusing should the transformer be wound incorrectly or if one of the Mosfets fails as a short circuit. Power-on indication is via LED1, powered via a 2.2kΩ resistor from the 12V supply. Construction The Ultrasonic Cleaner is constructed on a PC board coded 04208101 and measuring 104 x 78mm. It is mounted in an IP65 ABS box with a clear lid and measuring 115 x 90 x 55mm. The clear lid allows the power and running LEDs to be seen without having to drill extra holes. The PC board is designed to mount onto the mounting bushes inside the box. Make sure the PC board is shaped to the correct outline so it fits into the box. It can be filed to shape if necessary using the PC board outline as a guide. Begin construction by checking the PC board for breaks in tracks or shorts between tracks and pads. Repair if necessary. Check the hole sizes are correct for each component 62  Silicon Chip Taken at a low sweep speed, this waveform shows the transducer driven with bursts of different frequencies. In this case the maximum peak-peak voltage is 900V. Danger!! 1 FIRST WIND THE SECONDARY, USING 0.25mm ENAMELLED COPPER WIRE: TWO 45-TURN LAYERS, STARTING FROM PIN 4 AND ENDING AT PIN 3. PLACE ONE LAYER OF PLASTIC INSULATING TAPE OVER EACH LAYER. 6 45 TURNS 5 45 TURNS 4 S3 7 8 9 10 3 F3 11 2 12 1 13 ETD29 FORMER UNDERSIDE (PIN SIDE) VIEW 4 TURNS 2 THEN WIND THE PRIMARY, USING 14 x 0.20mm FIGURE-8 CABLE IN TWO LAYERS EACH OF 4 TURNS. TERMINATE THE START WIRES AT PINS 7 & 10 AND THE FINISH WIRES AT PINS 7 & 12. NOTE THE STRIPE WIRE TERMINATIONS. 6 4 TURNS S1, 7 F2 5 8 4 S3 9 S2 10 3 F3 11 2 F1 12 1 13 Fig.4: winding details for the on-board transformer, T1. The secondaries are conventional enamelled copper wire while the primaries are wound with figure-8 wire. to fit neatly. The screw terminal holes and transformer pin holes are 1.25mm in diameter compared to the 0.9mm holes for the ICs, resistors and diodes. Larger holes again are used for the DC socket and fuse clips. Normally, power can be switched on and off by switching the plugpack at the power point. However, if you prefer to have a separate switch for the Ultrasonic Cleaner, we have provided the option to include a power on and off switch (S2) that is wired between two PC stakes on the PC board. If you are not using the switch then the PC stakes do not need to be installed. If you are using a switch, then the PC stakes are installed and the thinned track between the PC stakes is broken using hobby knife. PC stakes are required to be installed for the three connection points for VR1. Assembly can begin by the inserting the resistors. When inserting the resistors, use the resistor colour code table to siliconchip.com.au help in reading the resistor values. A digital multimeter can also be used to measure each value. The diodes can now be installed, with the orientation as shown. Note that there are four different diode types: 1N5819’s for D1 and D2, 1N4004 for D3 and 1N4148’s for D4-D7. It’s probably safest to install D4-D7 first, being all the same type. IC1 is mounted on a DIP8 socket, with the notch positioned as shown. Install the socket now but leave IC1 out for the time being. The crystal (X1), the DC socket and the two 2-way screw terminals can be installed next, with the screw terminals oriented with the opening toward the outside edge of the PC board. Q1 and Q2 are mounted so that their metal tabs face the transformer and are about 25mm above the PC board. REG1 can also be mounted now. None of these components require heatsinks. The LEDs are mounted with the top of each LED 30mm above the PC board. Again, take care with orientation: the anode has the longer lead. Capacitors can be mounted next ensuring the electrolytic types are oriented correctly. The two main supply electrolytics (4700µF 16V) must be low ESR types. Winding the transformer Fig.4 shows the transformer winding details. The primary winding uses standard polarity-marked figure-8 wire, either 14 x 0.20mm or 14 x 0.18mm, wound in two layers. The secondary uses 0.25mm enamelled copper wire wound in two layers with a layer of insulation tape between the first and second layers. Start by winding the secondary winding. First, remove the enamel from the one end of the 0.25mm enamelled copper wire (use some fine emery paper or a hobby knife to scrape it off). Pre-tin the wire end and wrap it around pin 4 on the underside of the transformer bobbin and solder close to the bobbin. Now close-wind 45 turns (ie, side-by-side) until the windings reach the opposite end of the former. The direction of winding does not matter. Cover the windings in a layer of insulation tape. Continue winding back over the first layer, in the same direction as before (ie clockwise or anticlockwise) to complete 90 turns. Terminate the wire onto terminal 3 in the same way as was done for terminal 4. The primary winding, made from siliconchip.com.au Parts List – Ultrasonic Cleaner 1 PC board, 104 x 78mm, code 04208101 1 IP65 ABS box with clear lid, 115 x 90 x 55mm (Jaycar HB6246 or equivalent) 1 panel label 84 x 80mm 1 12V 2.5A plugpack 1 50W ultrasonic transducer with 40kHz resonance 1 65mm PVC DWV (Drain, Waste and Vent) end cap 1 65mm PVC pipe 40mm long to suit end cap 1 ETD29 transformer with 2 x 3C85 cores a 13-pin former and 2 retaining clips (T1) 1 2.5mm PC mount DC socket (CON1) 1 SPST momentary closed panel switch (S1) 1 SPDT toggle switch (S2) (optional) 1 3A M205 fuse (F1) 2 M205 fuse clips 2 2-way screw terminals (CON2, CON3) 1 DIP8 IC socket for IC1 1 knob to suit VR1 2 cables gland for 6mm cable 1 20MHz crystal (X1) 3 PC stakes (for VR1 terminals on PC board) 2 PC stakes (optional for S2) 2 solder lugs (Ultrasonic Transducer terminals) 2 M4 x 10mm screws (Ultrasonic Transducer solder lugs) 2 M4 nuts (Ultrasonic Transducer solder lugs) 2 4mm star washers (Ultrasonic Transducer solder lugs) 4 M3 x 6mm screws (PC board to case) 1m twin core mains flex (Ultrasonic Transducer lead) 1 300mm length of 14 x 0.20mm or 14 x 0.18mm fig-8 wire (primary T1) 1 3m length of 0.25mm enamelled copper wire (secondary T1) the figure-8 cable, is first stripped of insulation at about 10mm from the ends and the two wires are soldered close to the bobbin at pin 7 and pin 10. Place the wire with the polarity stripe to pin 7. Now wind on four turns making sure the wire lies flat without twisting so the striped wire stays to the left. The four turns should fully fill the 1 300mm length of black hookup wire (S1 and VR1) 1 50mm length of red hookup wire (VR1) 1 50mm length of blue hookup wire (VR1) 1 100mm length of yellow hookup wire (optional for S2) 1 240mm length of 2mm heatshrink tubing (VR1 and PC stakes and S1 terminals) 1 40mm length of 5mm heatshrink tubing (Ultrasonic transducer terminals) 1 40mm length of 5mm black heatshrink tubing (LED1,LED2 covering) Semiconductors 1 PIC12F675-I/P programmed with 0420810A (IC1) 1 78L05 5V regulator (REG1) 2 RFP30N06LE 30A 60V Logic level Mosfets (Q1,Q2) 2 1N4733 5.1V 1W zener diodes (ZD1,ZD2) 1 1N4004 1A diode (D3) 4 1N4148 switching diodes (D4-D7) 2 1N5819 1A Schottky diodes (D1,D2) 2 3mm LEDs (LED1,LED2) Capacitors 2 4700µF 16V low ESR 2 100µF 16V 1 10µF 16V 2 100nF MKT polyester 2 22pF ceramic Resistors (0.25W 1%) 1 22kΩ 1 10kΩ 2 2.2kΩ 1 100Ω 2 10Ω 1 10kΩ linear pot with knob (VR1) Miscellaneous Neutral cure silicone sealant suitable for wet areas (eg roof and gutter sealant) Epoxy resin (eg. J-B Weld) bobbin and the next four turns will be on the next layer (there’s no need for insulation tape between them). Terminate the striped wire end onto pin 12 and the other wire to pin 7. Once wound, slide the cores into the former and secure with the clips. These clips push on to the core ends and clip into lugs on the side of the bobbin. The transformer can be inA August ugust 2010  63 This scope waveform shows the cleaner in continuous mode whereby it is swept over a small range of frequencies centred around 40kHz. Taken at a low sweep speed, this shows that transducer drive is continuous rather than being pulsed at different frequencies. stalled into the PC board holes and soldered in place. Install T1 on the PC board noting that the primary side has seven pins and the secondary side has six pins. That completes the PC board assembly. overhead projector film, then mark out and drill the holes in the clear lid. The label is mounted inside the lid to protect it. Cut the holes out for the switch and potentiometer using a hobby knife, then attach it to the lid using clear tape, spray adhesive or clear silicone sealant. The switch and potentiometer are wired as shown using hookup wire and heatshrink tubing over the soldered terminations. The heatshrink tubing helps prevent the wires from breaking off the terminals. Note that the switch is best attached to the lid before connecting the wires to the PC board. The potentiometer can be wired while it is off the lid and attached after wiring. So that light only shines through the lid where the power and running indications are located on the front panel label, the two LEDs are fitted with short “light tubes”. We used approx. 20mm lengths of 5mm tubing and temporarily inserted the DC plug from the 12V plugpack into one end of the tubing to about 4mm inside the tube end. This acted as a heatshrink tubing former. Then the other end of the heatshrink tube was placed over the LED and the tubing was shrunk down using a heat gun. The DC plug was removed after the tubing had cooled leaving a round tube shape above the LED. Without the DC plug inserted first, the tube would shrink up too tightly. Holes are required in the ends of the box for the power connector and for the cable gland for the lead to the ultrasonic transducer. The power connector hole is 8mm in diameter and is located 31mm to the right of the outside left box edge and 16mm up from the outside base of the box. The 12mm cable gland hole is located on the opposite end of the box, 27mm up from the base edge and in the centre. The case Cut the potentiometer shaft so that it is 12mm long or to suit the knob used. The front-panel label shows the positioning for the start switch and the potentiometer that mount on the lid. This label can be downloaded from our website as a .PDF file. Print it out onto paper or clear Supply check Here’s how it goes together in the case. Only the timer pot (VR1) and the start switch (S1) are mounted on the lid of the case, which is translucent to allow the LEDs to shine through. 64  Silicon Chip The 12V 2.5A plugpack is supplied with several connectors. Choose the one that fits the DC socket, then attach this connector to the DC plugpack lead with the + marking on the connector plug to the + marking on the connector socket. With the plug removed from the DC socket, check that there is 12V at the connector plug and that the centre hole is the + terminal and the outside is the – terminal. siliconchip.com.au The transducer “potted” into some PVC plumbing fittings with silicone sealant, ready for attachment to a suitable cleaning tank. Make sure the terminals are covered! Now check that IC1 is OUT of its socket and remove fuse F1 (this step is important for safety reasons and to ensure F1 doesn’t blow with IC1 out of circuit). That done, plug the DC connector into the DC socket and check that there is 5V between pins 1 & 8 of IC1’s socket (pin 1 should be at +5V with respect to pin 8). In practice, this voltage could be between 4.85V and 5.15V but will typically be close to 5V. If the voltage is correct, switch off and place the board to one side. DO NOT install IC1 or the fuse – that comes later. Piezoelectric transducer Note that the voltage at CON3 and thus across the terminals of the piezoelectric transducer can be up to 900V peak-to-peak or so (see scope waveforms) – so avoid contact with these terminals when the driver is running. THIS VOLTAGE IS POTENTIALLY LETHAL! Use 2-core sheathed mains cord for wiring to the ultrasonic transducer. The wire terminates onto solder lugs and is covered with heat shrink tubing. The terminals are secured to the ultrasonic transducer terminals using an M4 screw, star washer and M4 nut for each. These terminals on the transducer are exposed and need to be protected within a housing to prevent contact. A suitable housing is made up using 65mm PVC DWV (Drain, Waste and Vent) fittings. As mentioned, the Ultrasonic transducer can be directly inserted into a bath if the transducer is raised sufficiently so that the lower 5mm of the transducer is immersed in the fluid. A typical housing is shown in the photo on page 58. Alternatively, the transducer can be secured to the outside RESISTOR COLOUR CODES No. 1   1 1   1 1   2 1   1 1   2 Value 22kΩ 10kΩ 2.2kΩ 100Ω 10Ω siliconchip.com.au 4-Band Code (1%) red red orange brown brown black orange brown red red red brown brown black brown brown brown black black brown Keeping the plumbing theme going(!), here’s our cleaning tank: an old cistern, with holes suitably plugged, with the smooth face of the transducer glued directly to the outside of the case using J-B Weld. You could use just about any metal or plastic leakproof container as a tank. Ours works a treat! of a “bath” using epoxy resin as shown above. We used an end cap and a 40mm length of pipe to house the transducer. The wire entry is via a cord grip grommet that secures to the end cap so that the wires cannot be pulled out to leave exposed live wires. Shape the cord grip grommet hole so that it is captured correctly within the end cap and holds the wire securely. The twin core sheathed cable we used was not held securely with the cord grip grommet and so we looped the cable in an ‘S’ shape so that three layers of the wire are captured in the grommet. The transducer should be mounted within the enclosure using neutral cure silicone sealant (such as roof and gutter sealant). The lower section of the transducer should be kept free from the sealant. This is so that the transducer can more effectively couple to the liquid in the bath either directly or when secured to the outside of the bath with epoxy resin. Make sure the electrical terminals are covered with silicone to provide insulation and prevent accidental contact. Connecting the ultrasonic driver cable to the PC board is best done before the board is mounted in the box. Ensure the power is off and pass the 2-core sheathed mains cord through the cable gland locking nut, the cable gland itself (which means it goes through the box) and carefully connect the two wires to the output terminals (CON3). Make absolutely sure there are no strands of copper wire emerging from the terminals which could short them out. The Ultrasonic Cleaner PC board 5-Band Code (1%) red red black red brown brown black black red brown red red black brown brown brown black black black brown brown black black gold brown Capacitor Codes Value µF Value IEC Code EIA Code 100nF 0.1µF 100n 104 22pF NA 22p 22 August 2010  65 can now be installed in the box and secured using the four M3 x 6mm screws. That done, pull the 2-core mains cable through the cable gland so it has a just little slack inside the box and secure the cable with the locking nut on the gland. Finally, complete the assembly by installing IC1 and the fuse (make sure the power is off), then fit the case lid. The bath When the Ultrasonic transducer is directly inserted into the bath, the bath can be made of almost any suitable material ranging from plastics through to glass and metal. For external attachment of the Ultrasonic transducer, the bath can be made from stainless steel, aluminium or plastic that couples the ultrasonic vibration through into the fluid. Thinner materials couple the ultrasonics with less loss. Ideally the bath should have a flat side or base where the transducer can be attached. The material also needs to be compatible with the epoxy resin used to glue the transducer to the bath. Metals are the most compatible material. Larger sized baths with more liquid will have a lesser cleaning effect than smaller containers with less fluid. A 200mm diameter or smaller cylindrical container or a similar sized rectangular bath size could be used with up to one litre of fluid in the bath. This is ideal for the ultrasonic sensor and driver. Alternatively a stainless steel kitchen sink can be pressed into service. The fluid used in the bath can be water with a few drops of detergent as a wetting agent. Other fluids that can be used include methylated spirits. Cleaning effectiveness is greatly enhanced when the fluid is warmed. Normal operation of the Ultrasonic Cleaner is where the frequency is cycled over the 19kHz to 42kHz range. Firstly, set the timer as shown on the front panel label for up to 10m. Pressing the start switch begins the cleaning cycle. The cleaning can be stopped at any time by rotating the timer potentiometer fully anticlockwise or switching off power. Power is indicated with an LED, while cleaning operation is shown with a second LED. The running operation will show the LED with a small amount of flickering. For stubborn hard to clean components, you can set the driver mode to the alternative setting. To do this switch off power and wait until the power LED is out. Then press the start switch and apply power. Hold the switch for a couple of seconds and then release the switch. This sets the alternative driver cycle that centres about 40kHz. Note that it is recommended that this alternative mode be only used intermittently and for less than a few minutes since the Mosfet and transformer run hot during this cycle. To return to the normal mode, firstly switch off power and wait again until the power LED is out. Then press the start switch and apply power. Hold the switch for a couple of seconds and then release the switch. This will return the cleaner to the normal driver cycle. So how can you identify which cycle is running? The setting when the Ultrasonic Cleaner is first built is the normal cycle. For this cycle, the running LED will flicker on and off and the transducer will emit its own distinctive audible sound. And yes the transducer is ultrasonic but some sound is heard as the transducer is swept over frequency. Sub harmonics and the frequency modulation are audible. For the alternative cycle, the running LED will be virtually flicker-free and the audible sound will differ SC from the normal cycle mode. Why is Ultrasonic Cleaning effective? A component that has contaminants on its outside layer can be cleaned by physical removal of the contaminants or by dissolving the contaminant. Which process works depends upon the contaminant. FIG.6 For example solids are more effectively removed by physical means whereas oils are better removed by dissolving in solution. Sometimes a combination of physical dislodging and chemical dissolving of contaminants is necessary to remove various combinations of contaminants. Ultrasonic energy improves both the dissolving and physical removal of the contaminant. Where ultrasonics is used as an aid in the dissolving process can be seen in the Figures from Fig.6 to Fig.8. Fig.6 shows a component that has a contaminant adhered to its surface that is placed in a cleaning fluid solution. As the cleaning fluid begins to dissolve the contaminant, it becomes saturated with the contaminant and so it loses its effectiveness in cleaning. This is seen in Fig.7. FIG.7 However, as shown in Fig.8, when ultrasonic excitation is included in the cleaning process, the saturated cleaning fluid is displaced allowing fresh cleaning fluid to come into contact with the contaminant to dissolve it. As shown, the component surface is a flat edge that could be cleaned with a mechanical method other than ultrasonics. For irregular and internal surfaces on a component, ultrasonics is very effective because it can reach where other mechanical removal means is impossible to gain access to the contaminated surfaces. Where the contaminant comprises solids that are not dissolved by the cleaning fluid, ultrasonics also aids in removing these particles from the component surface. However, the cleaning fluid must wet the particles so that this fluid can then carry the particle away FIG.8 from the component surface. The ultrasonics assists in the removal of the particle from the component and in the motion of the cleaning fluid as it carries the contaminant away from the component site. It is also possible that ultrasonics may increase the rate of chemical action in the dissolving of contaminants. 66  Silicon Chip CLEANING FLUID COMPONENT Fig.6 SURFACE CONTAMINANT CLEANING FLUID COMPONENT Fig.7 SATURATED CLEANING FLUID CLEANING FLUID CAVITATION BUBBLES COMPONENT Fig.8 SATURATED CLEANING FLUID siliconchip.com.au CIRCUIT NOTEBOOK Interesting circuit ideas which we have checked but not built and tested. Contributions from readers are welcome and will be paid for at standard rates. +12V 330 100nF 10k 10k RF INPUT RF OUTPUT C B 100nF Q3 BC547 E 100nF B C 100nF Q1 BF199 12k E 100nF 10nF G T1 470 56 5.6nF Lx 50T D S 1T VC 10M D2 BAT54 Q2 2N5485 A K D1 BAT54 1k + VR1 5k K 100 A METER 5.6nF A – BF199 Check inductors with this simple Q meter While LCR meters are readily available at reasonable cost, they do not measure the Q of an inductor. This circuit enables you to measure the Q of inductors with the aid of an RF signal generator. A capacitor is connected in parallel with the inductor to form a tuned circuit. By varying the frequency, you can measure the resonance frequency of the tuned circuit and its -3dB bandwidth. The Q is then the resonance frequency divided by the -3dB bandwidth. Transistor Q1 is an emitter follower acting as input buffer to drive RF transformer T1. The secondary winding of T1 then drives the parallel tuned circuit formed by the inductor under test (Lx), T1’s secondary and tuning capacitor VC. The tuned circuit so formed is buffered by JFET Q2 and transistor Q3 which form a cascode stage with about 3dB of gain. The JFET provides a high impedance so that the loading of the tuned circuit is minimal (note: an MPF102 can be substituted if you cannot obtain a 2N5485). The RF output from Q2's collector can be monitored by an oscilloscope to easily find the point of resonance and read the frequency. Alternasiliconchip.com.au BAT54 A B E K B tively, the RF output can be read by an external frequency meter. Diodes D1 & D2 and the 5.6nF capacitors form a voltage doubler rectifier to drive a 100µA DC meter so that the resonance can be found (in the absence of an oscilloscope). Trimpot VR1 provides a sensitivity adjustment for the meter. Transformer T1 is wound on a 12mm diameter ferrite toroid core. The primary winding consists of 50 turns of 0.2mm diameter enamelled copper wire, while the secondary is a single turn consisting of a strip of brass 0.5mm thick and 2.5mm wide bent into a horseshoe shape and threaded through the centre of the toroid. VC is a small AM tuning capacitor with both gangs connected in parallel. To measure Q, the output of the RF signal generator should be around 0.5V peak. Adjust the frequency until the meter's reading peaks, then adjust VR1 so that the meter reads full scale (100µA). Read the resonance frequency F0 from the frequency scale of the signal generator or better still, the reading on a frequency meter. Next, increase the signal frequency until the meter reads 70µA and 2N5485 BC547 C E S C G D note this frequency as F2. That done, reduce the frequency on the signal generator below the resonance frequency until the meter again reads 70µA and note this frequency as F1. The Q can now be calculated as: Q = F0/(F2 - F1) While using a variable tuning capacitor will enable a wider range of inductors to be tested, the main advantage is estimating the distributed capacitance of the inductor as well. To do this, you have to calibrate the tuning scale with a capacitance meter, by measuring the capacitance across the tuning capacitor with no inductor connected. This is done with the unit switched off. Marking off increments of 20pF should be sufficient. Set the tuning capacitor to say ¼ of its maximum value and note this value as C1. Adjust the RF signal generator frequency so that the inductor under test is at resonance and note this frequency as F0. Now set the RF generator frequency to half F0, adjust the tuning capacitor until resonance and note this capacitance as C2. The distributed capacitance of the inductor is (C2 - 4C1)/3. Alex Sum, Eastwood, NSW. ($45) August 2010  67 Circuit Notebook – Continued PART OF T1 D1 1N4004 A K 15V ADDED 1N4004 DIODES REG1 7815 IN OUT GND 1000 F 25V 10 F 35V 1000 F 25V K GND IN OUT A A K 10 F 35V 100 F 25V A REG2 7915 D2 1N4004 +15V K 100 F 25V –15V 1N4004 A K Adding protection diodes to positive/negative regulator circuits With any regulated split power supply (ie, one with positive and negative voltage outputs), it's good practice to add diodes between both outputs and ground, orientated so that they are reverse-biased during normal operation. These diodes are necessary because without them, the positive output can be pulled below ground by the negative regulator (or vice versa) via the load or output capacitors. Depending on the specific regulators used, this can result in a “latch-up” condition whereby one regulator cannot start, so only one output voltage rail is present. Typically, this will mean that the negative regulated output is present but the positive rail is not operative. The above diagram shows the Ultra-LD Preamplifier power supply (SILICON CHIP, November 2001-January 2002) with these diodes added, to fix this oversight in the original design. The original circuit works with National Semiconductor LM­ 7815 and LM7915 regulators but +12V 0.1  5W 100nF 1k 1 F E B Q1 BC327 C 3.3M 4.7nF 100nF B E C + MOTOR – Q2 BC327 1k 3.3M SQUARE WAVE PULSES TO COUNTER 4.7k 4.7k 0V DC motor speed sensing All DC motors with commutators have a current which fluctuates due to the intermittent contact of the brushes and commutator segments. This fluctuation is greater for motors with a small number of segments and smaller for commutators with 68  Silicon Chip BC327 B E C a larger number of segments. Either way, the frequency of the current fluctuation is directly proportional to the motor speed. This circuit monitors the AC component of the motor current which is sensed by a 0.1Ω 5W resistor. problems can occur if an ST Micro or other branded 7815 is used. The ST Micro regulator will not start if its output is pulled below -0.7V. This can easily happen when the unregulated DC inputs come from half-wave rectifiers (as in the case of the Ultra-LD preamp). Depending on when power is applied, one regulator can turn on fully before the other one is properly powered up from its DC input. When that happens, the “victim” regulator, if we can call it that, has its output pulled below (or above) ground and this brings the short-circuit protection into operation. The diodes prevent this latchup condition by conducting and preventing the “victim” output from going any more than 0.7V (one diode drop) beyond ground. They can be soldered to the rear of the Ultra-LD preamplifier board. If this board has already been installed, they can be carefully added without removing it from the case. Note, however that they are not really necessary unless the amplifier sometimes fails to operate when switched on. Nicholas Vinen, SILICON CHIP. The circuit consists of two common-emitter gain stages to amplify the AC signal from the sensing resistor to the point where it can be read by a frequency counter. Both transistor stages are AC-coupled so that they are not affected by the DC voltage across the sensing resistor. This circuit was used to sense the speed of a standard 12V windscreen wiper motor. The value and power rating of the sensing resistor may need to be altered to suit higher or lower powered motors. Note also that the circuit may not work well if the motor is powered from a switchmode power supply which has significant hash superimposed on its output. If the output signal is to be monitored by a microprocessor, it should be clipped to a safe level by diodes or a suitable zener diode. Gerard La Rooy, Christchurch, NZ. ($40) siliconchip.com.au +6V 390 A 3.3k LED E B C B BC547  BC557 E B C E BC557 B BC547 C G E G 'OFF' S2 1k 0V 0V 1 3 4 +V BC557 TRIGGER LEAD OF LV FLASH C C  B  – B BC557 E LOAD BC557 C C B E 1k PHOTO TRANSISTOR C C B BC547 B BC547 E 1k 1k 0V 6 + E B BC557 0V 5  LDR  E C 1k +V LOAD E B C E +V LOAD E B PHOTO TRANSISTOR K 47 0V 2 + B  E K BC557 C C G E B 'ON' S1 K C A A (LOAD) 0V 7 8 + PHOTO TRANSISTOR BC547, BC557  E B BC557 C C BC547 E PHOTO TRANSISTOR  TRIGGER LEAD OF LV FLASH 3V BATTERY A 10nF G K B SCR C106D1 TRIGGER LEAD OF LV FLASH E B 10k 1k C106D 1k – 9 SCR circuits based on discrete transistors While high-power SCRs are relatively easy to obtain, low power and sensitive gate SCRs can now be quite difficult to find. The same comment applies to opto SCRs and gate-turn off SCRs. However, it is possible to obtain SCR functions by interconnecting low power NPN and PNP transistors as shown in Fig.1. This configuration is shown in a conventional SCR circuit which has standard gate triggering. This C A – K 10 can also provide a gate turn-off function with the addition of the switch shown in Fig.3. Gate turn-off is normally only available in some high power SCRs. By substituting a phototransistor for the NPN device, you can produce a light activated SCR or LASCR (Fig.4) which are now unavailable. When the LASCR is illuminated, it turns on and will stay on. It could be used in the flash trigger circuit shown in Fig.5, provided that the flash trigger is a low voltage arrangement (eg, 6V). Issues Getting Dog-Eared? A G A. J. L Other examples is this m owe of light-triggered on winner th’s SCR circuits are o P e ak Atla f a shown in the res Test Instrum maining circuits, ent with the example of Fig.10 being suitable where the flash trigger is a high voltage. The maximum “SCR” current is limited by the transistor baseemitter rating, in these cases to 100mA. A. J. Lowe, Bardon, Qld. Keep your copies safe with our handy binders Available Aust only. Price: $A14.95 plus $10.00 p&p per order (includes GST). Just fill in and mail the handy order form in this issue or ring (02) 9939 3295 and quote your credit card number. siliconchip.com.au August 2010  69 Circuit Notebook – Continued ON/OFF +4.8V B 1k S1 CONTROL BUTTON 4 7 P3 P0 2 SER IN 10k PROGRAMMING SOCKET E B 22k 1 Vdd P4 3 λ 6 150Ω λ 150Ω LED6 λ A λ A λ E Q2 BC327 C LED3 A S5 Q1 BC337 100nF 10 µF 16V 10 µF 16V K 6V (4 CELLS) LED5 K –1.2V LED7 K K K A 330Ω λ K A Vss 8 LED4 A K A IC1 5 PICAXE P2 -08 P1 150Ω LED2 C 10Ω LED1 λ K D1 K 8Ω SPEAKER 10k D2 A 0V ONE = LED1 TWO = LED2 & LED 3 THREE = LED1, LED2 & LED3 FOUR = LED2, LED3, LED6 & LED7 FIVE = LED1, LED2, LED3, LED6 & LED7 SIX = LED2, LED3, LED4, LED5, LED6 & LED7 Playing dice games with a PICAXE08M This circuit enables you to play three separate dice games. It’s quite straightforward and is based on a PICAXE08M microprocessor and its associated programming socket, a single pushbutton switch, seven LEDs arranged in a matrix to provide a dice display, a speaker, a power switch and a 6V battery. Diodes D1 & D2 are included to reduce the voltage on the PICAXE to 4.8V while still allowing the seriesconnected LEDs to run from the full 6V supply. The voltage drop across the LEDs will prevent the higher voltage reaching the PICAXE output pins and causing damage. A table on the circuit diagram indicates which LEDs are driven LED7 LED2 LED4 LED6 LED1 LED5 LEDS D1, D2: 1N4004 LED3 A for each dice number. Up to three PICAXE outputs are needed to display the larger numbers. There are three separate dice games in the program listing: Standard Dice, Musical Dice and Rolling Dice. Each game features sound and music and also the ability for the dice to automatically roll. You must choose a game each time the power is switched on. The centre will show one LED, then two LEDs, then three LEDs and the sequence will be repeated. You select the game to be played by pressing the button to match the number of LEDs turned on to the number of the game required. Standard Dice displays a random number between one and six each time you press the button. The only sound in this game is a beep each time the button is pressed. K K A A BC327, BC337 B E C Musical Dice is the same as above except that each time a six is thrown, you hear music playing. After the music (from the Batman Movie) is finished playing, the program will pause and the display will be blanked and will wait for the pushbutton to be pressed to restart the game. Musical dice can be used in a “pass the parcel style” party game where the parcel is passed from child to child – with each child pressing the pushbutton before passing the parcel on until the music is heard and the child holding the parcel wins a small gift. Rolling Dice adds more variation in that the dice throws are now automatic and do not depend on the pushbutton being pressed; the pushbutton is only needed after the music stops to restart the game. C h o o s e Yo u r P r i z e There are now five great reasons to send in your circuit idea for publication in SILICON CHIP. We pay for each item published or better still, the best item in “Circuit Notebook” each month will entitle the author to choose one of four prizes: (1) an LCR40 LCR meter, (2) a DCA55 Semiconductor Component Analyser, (3) an ESR60 Equivalent Series Resistance Analyser or (4) an SCR100 Thyristor & Triac Analyser, with the compliments of 70  Silicon Chip Peak Electronic Design Ltd. See their website at www.peakelec.co.uk So now you have even more reasons to send that brilliant circuit in. Send it to SILICON CHIP and you could be a winner. You can either email your idea to silchip<at>siliconchip.com.au or post it to PO Box 139, Collaroy, NSW 2097. siliconchip.com.au C E B Q1–Q4: BC548 0V CHIP EN D8 8 K A D1 K (D2–D7 NOT A SHOWN) 11 8 O5-9 12 O9 CP1 Vss 9 O8 13 15 1 8.2nF 100k Q4 10k E C 100k 10k E B Q3 C 10k E 10k Q1 B 10k 470 µF 2.2k B C 10k 220 µF 2.2k 100k B 10k 1k 1k E C Q2 August 2010  71 K A D1–D8: 1N4148 1k 4 IC4b 5 10k 6 5 5 2 6 8 IC1 555 4 3 14 MR O7 O4 CP0 O6 IC2 4017B O5 1 7 10 O3 O2 4 2 O1 Vdd O0 3 10k 10k 16 7 siliconchip.com.au START S1 The games are based on a random number generator working within a range of 0-255. This is divided into six bands of approximately 42 numbers and each band is assigned one number on the dice face. Another variation is a Ticking Bomb Game whereby only three LEDs are employed and it ticks once a second. When the bomb goes off there is no explosion but it plays the Death March. The PICAXE “sound” command is used for the pushbutton beeps and the “tune” command for the music. All the sounds and tunes can be changed and at the end of the listing are six additional short tunes that may be used to provide variation. Note that the speaker output from IC1 at P2 also drives LED4 & LED5 and these will flash when any sound is played. Ian Robertson, Engadine, NSW. ($50) Note: the two program listings 3dicegames_pgm. bas and tickingbomb_pgm.bas can be downloaded from the SILICON CHIP website. M8 EN ON VOICE RECORDER MODULE (IC3c-f AND IC4a INVERTERS NOT SHOWN) M2 EN 5 3 1 IC3b IC3a 2 4 1k 1k +5V This circuit will provide for random playback of one of eight messages from the SILICON CHIP Voice Recorder (December 2007) each time a pushbutton is pressed. It comprises two monostable pulse generators, based on transistor pairs Q1 & Q2 and Q3 & Q4. Pressing the pushbutton initiates both monostables which each produce a single high output pulse. The monostable based on Q1 & Q2 produces a 300ms pulse which enables an oscillator based on 555 timer IC1, running at about 1.2kHz. This clocks counter IC2. At the same time, the 300ms pulse is fed to the enable input on the Voice Recorder. IC2 counts for the duration of the clock input and one of the eight outputs will then go high and stay that way until the clock is retriggered. This high is buffered by the associated section of a 4049 quad inverter (IC3 & IC4) and the resulting low signal is used to trigger the appropriate input on the Voice Recorder. The second monostable (Q3 & Q4) is configured for a high pulse of about 800ms and is connected to the eight outputs of IC2 via D1-D8. During the monostable pulse, both ends of the diodes are high and the Voice Recorder can be activated. About 500ms after the count stops, the monostable output returns to low and takes all the outputs of the 4017 low. The inputs to the Voice Recorder thus go high again and playback does not repeat until it is re-triggered. Nicholas Dunand, Ascot Vale, Vic. ($40) M1 EN Random playback trigger for the Voice Recorder HAMEG HMF2550 50MHz Arbitrary Function Generator This signal generator can deliver a 14-bit arbitrary waveform at 250 megasamples per second, a sine or square wave up to 50MHz or a triangle wave up to 10MHz. It can modulate the amplitude, frequency or phase by another generated or external waveform. It also does Pulse Width Modulation (PWM), Frequency Shift Keying (FSK) and more. B ecause the Hameg HMF2550 is an arbitrary function generator, it can produce practically any repetitive waveform shape with up to 256,000 distinct points. Generating sine, square and triangle waves is easy since they are pre-programmed and accessible via dedicated front panel buttons. The square wave has an adjustable duty cycle while the triangle wave has adjustable symmetry. It has several other wave shapes stored in ROM such as sawtooth, noise, cardinal sine (“sampling function” or “sinc”) and exponential sawtooth. User-defined waveforms can be stored in RAM or on a USB flash memory drive. They can be entered manually via the front panel (a tedious process), saved from a computer or captured from a Hameg oscilloscope. It also has a pulse output mode which is ideal for synthesising signals compatible with digital logic inputs. The unit The HMF2550 is housed in a slim, attractive case about two rack units high. The control panel is uncluttered despite the many pushbuttons, some of which illuminate to show the current mode. The display is a 9cm colour TFT Review by Nicholas Vinen 72  Silicon Chip siliconchip.com.au LCD which is small but also bright and sharp. Three BNC connectors are mounted on the front panel – the signal output, the trigger input and the trigger output. The trigger output is useful for synchronising an oscilloscope or another signal generator. There is also a USB connector for connection of flash drives containing custom waveforms. There are four more BNC sockets on the rear panel – the external modulation input, the ramp output (more on this later), the 10MHz frequency reference output and a frequency reference input for synchronisation. There is also a second USB port for connection to a computer along with an RS-232 serial port and the mains power socket. Accessories supplied include the power cord, user manual and software CD. User interface In general the HMF2550 is easy to use. Its major modes are directly accessible via dedicated, illuminated buttons. The TFT display shows the the current generator settings as well as a rough depiction of the output waveform shape. The Sine, Square, Triangle, Pulse and Arbitrary buttons select the main output mode with a single press. Another three buttons enable Modulation, Sweep or Burst (one at a time). Central to the front panel is the sixteen-button keypad used to enter values (frequencies, voltages, times, etc). Value entry is made simple by the four unit scale buttons to the right of the digits. For example, to enter a frequency, you type a number and then press either “MHz”, “kHz”, “Hz” or “mHz”. This is intuitive as numbers can be entered in whatever scale you prefer. These scale buttons are labelled with other units too. So if a voltage is being entered, they become “V”, “mV”, “dBm” or “%”. For time entry they become “ns”, “s”, “ms” or “s”. Alternatively, these values can all be varied by rotating the knob, although that is really only useful for small adjustments. Generally the knob (and the four arrows arranged around it) is used to select the field to be manipulated. The three quick access buttons above the output BNC socket are a nice touch, allowing the user to toggle the output on or off, enable or disable the output offset voltage or invert the output signal with a single press. The remainder of this unit’s functions are accessed via the menu button and five “soft” buttons arranged alongside the display, whose function changes depending upon the current mode. Much of the time they are used as short cuts to select a field to be manipulated (frequency, amplitude, modulation type etc). Unfortunately, some of the functions do not respond instantly to button presses. There can be delays of half a second or more when switching modes but simple functions such as changing the frequency or amplitude via the keypad are quite fast so it is generally not a major issue. Fig.1: the amplitude modulation feature in action. The 20V peak-peak 1MHz sine wave is being modulated by a lower frequency triangle wave over 100% of the amplitude range. Fig.2: here the generator has the same settings as in Fig.1 but using frequency modulation, with a large amount of frequency deviation to make it more obvious. Features The first extended mode is Modulation, where a second waveform can be used to modulate the signal. This waveform can be another arbitrary waveform or supplied via the analog modulation input. The supported modes are amplitude modulation (AM), frequency modulation (FM), phase modulation (PM), frequency shift keying (FSK) and pulse width modulation (PWM). In each case, the amount of modulation can be adjusted. siliconchip.com.au Fig.3: this image shows how the ramp output (blue trace) and trigger output (green trace) operate in sweep mode. The sweep is a 20Hz-20kHz sine wave at full amplitude. August 2010  73 The rear panel has the USB and RS-232 interfaces along with modulation input, sweep output and 10MHz reference input and output. In AM mode it is specified as a percentage of the amplitude, in FM mode the maximum frequency deviation, in PM mode the maximum phase deviation, in FSK the frequency hop size and in PWM mode the duty cycle percentage variation. The second extended mode is Sweep, where the signal frequency smoothly changes between the start and stop frequency with either linear or logarithmic timing. Simultaneously the ramp output sweeps linearly from 0V to 5V (see fig.3). This can be captured by another instrument and used to plot the frequency response of the device under test. The third extended mode is Burst, which repeats the waveform a specified number of times in a given time interval (see fig.4). Alternatively, the signal can be “gated” by an external source; ie, whenever the gating signal is low output is disabled and when it is high the output is enabled. The Pulse waveform functions differ from the other modes. When Pulse is selected, the output level varies between 0V and the specified voltage (say, 5V). The rise and fall times can be specified, as can the duty cycle. In this mode, only Pulse Width Modulation is possible (see fig.8). PWM can not be used in any other mode. As with other modulation modes, an internal or external signal can be used. The result is a pulse train at the specified frequency and average duty cycle, with the duty cycle varying with the modulating waveform level. This could be useful for testing switch-mode power supplies, motor control circuitry, Class D amplifiers or other such devices. Fig.4: burst mode, configured for 10 repetitions of a 1MHz sine wave every 33µs. The blue trace is the trigger waveform. Fig.5: the square wave output at 1MHz. There is some ringing after each transition but the rise and fall times are insignificant at this frequency and there is little rounding. 74  Silicon Chip Software The provided software allows for simple waveforms to be created or edited. It loads and saves CSV (Comma Separated Value) files which contains the co-ordinate data for the waveform. The files can be loaded onto the HMF2550 via the USB or serial interface, or by saving them onto a USB flash memory drive. However, the most likely source of arbitrary waveforms will be those recorded on an oscilloscope or mathematically generated. Since the HMF2550 accepts data in the common (and easy to create) CSV format, it is possible to convert data from many Digital Storage Oscilloscopes into a format siliconchip.com.au that the HMF2550 can handle using a spreadsheet program. The firmware can be upgraded via the USB flash drive interface. It is a good idea to keep the firmware up to date in order to take advantage of all the bug fixes and feature upgrades. Performance The sine wave output is visually undistorted from below 1Hz up to 50MHz. The specified harmonic distortion level is <0.04% up to 100kHz. We made our own sine wave distortion measurements at maximum amplitude (20V peak-to-peak) with a 10Hz500kHz measurement bandwidth and they are shown in the table below. In summary, our measurements are less than half the maximum specified distortion level. The signal to noise ratio under the same conditions is 92dB (unweighted). Frequency  THD+N Ratio 100Hz 1kHz 10kHz 100kHz 0.0127% 0.0128% 0.0140% 0.0180% Signal Amplitude (peak-to-peak) 19.800V 19.924V 19.896V 19.670V With square wave output, the rise and fall times are below 8ns so it remains fairly rectangular up to 1MHz. Between 1MHz and 10MHz it becomes more trapezoidal, with increasing ringing after the transitions and above 10MHz the signal becomes progressively more sinusoidal. The maximum triangle wave frequency is 10MHz but distortion is visible at 3MHz and becomes progressively more significant. The output voltage swing and drive strength are good with up to 20V peak-to-peak into light loads and 10V peakto-peak into 50Ω loads. It is possible to improve the frequency accuracy by feeding in an external 10MHz frequency source, but generally this is unnecessary due to the excellent temperature stability (±1ppm from 18°C-28°C) and excellent aging characteristics (±1ppm over one year) of the unit’s own reference. In fact the HMF2550 can be used as an accurate 10MHz reference clock source for other instruments. Fig.6: a 5MHz triangle wave, which is half of the maximum supported frequency. Some distortion is visible near the peaks – much more than there is at 1MHz. Fig.7: this is the maximum sine wave frequency provided by the HMF2550. Conclusion This is a very flexible signal generator which is easy to set up and use. The wide range of frequencies and amplitudes, and the ease with which user-defined signals can be integrated means that this instrument will meet a wide range of needs. Overall the interface is well designed and intuitive, although if you press the wrong button it can sometimes be confusing to get back to where you were. The most impressive aspect is the flexibility provided by the modulation options. The pulse and sweep modes are not quite as comprehensive as they could be but in reality this device can perform all the common analog signal generation functions that are needed within its supported frequency range. The HMF2550 (and 25MHz HMF2525) are available from Rohde & Schwarz Australia. Prices range between approximately $1900 and $2450 depending upon the model and configuration. The standard warranty is one year. Call (02) 8874 5100 or e-mail Sales.Australia<at>RohdeSchwarz.com for more information. SC siliconchip.com.au Fig.8: the pulse mode output at 1MHz. Note that it is not centred about 0V. It has been set for 10V peak amplitude and is being pulse-width-modulated by a sine wave. August 2010  75 SILICON CHIP If you are seeing a blank page here, it is more than likely that it contained advertising which is now out of date and the advertiser has requested that the page be removed to prevent misunderstandings. Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website: www.altronics.com.au/ SILICON CHIP If you are seeing a blank page here, it is more than likely that it contained advertising which is now out of date and the advertiser has requested that the page be removed to prevent misunderstandings. Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website: www.altronics.com.au/ SILICON CHIP If you are seeing a blank page here, it is more than likely that it contained advertising which is now out of date and the advertiser has requested that the page be removed to prevent misunderstandings. Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website: www.altronics.com.au/ SILICON CHIP If you are seeing a blank page here, it is more than likely that it contained advertising which is now out of date and the advertiser has requested that the page be removed to prevent misunderstandings. Please feel free to visit the advertiser’s website: www.altronics.com.au/ Electrolytic reformer an Got a bunch of old electrolytic capacitors you’d like to use . . . but don’t know if they are any good? Or do you need to re-form the electrolytics in an old valve amplifier or vintage radio set? This Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer and Tester will do the job for you, at any of 11 different standard voltages from 10V to 630V. I n addition, it provides the ability to apply the selected test voltage for any of seven periods ranging from 10 seconds to 60 minutes. Thus you can use it for ‘reforming’ electrolytic capacitors that have developed high leakage and high impedance due to years of inactivity. As well, it can be used to test the leakage of virtually all capacitors at or near their rated voltage. Of course, we have to state that not all old electrolytics can be restored – they can’t. Some will have very high leakage due to contamination of the can seal or breakdown of the electrolyte and some will have just dried out. In those cases, you cannot do anything to resurrect them but in many cases you will be able to restore and re-use Part 1: by JIM ROWE capacitors that have not been used for many years if not decades. Some very old caps (1960s vintage!) we had took several hours to come good while others, made in more recent years, were good within a few minutes. Most high voltage (ie, 250V and above) capacitors should be capable of being reformed to the extent that their leakage current drops to around 3mA or less. The Reformer circuit is designed so that no damage can occur if the capacitor connected to it is short circuit or has very high leakage, or is even connected back-to-front (ie, with reverse polarity). Furthermore, even if the capacitor leakage is very high, the output current is limited so that the maximum dissipation in the capacitor is no more than 2W. This means that some capacitors might get warm while they are being reformed but none will get so hot that they are in danger of swelling up and “letting the smoke out”. That’s a good thing because electrolytic capacitor smoke is particularly foul-smelling! And as any serviceman will tell you, the gunk (electrolyte) inside is particularly nasty if it escapes with the smoke. The Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer and Tester is housed not in a traditional instrument case or box but in a standard plastic storage organiser case WARNING: SHOCK HAZARD! Because the voltage source in this instrument can be set to provide quite high DC voltages (up to 630V) and can also supply significant current (tens of milliamps), it does represent a potential hazard in terms of electric shock. We have taken a great deal of care to ensure that this hazard is virtually zero if the instrument is used in the correct way – ie, with the lid closed and secured – even to the extent of quickly discharging any capacitor when the lid is opened. However, if the safety switching is bypassed, especially when the unit is set to one of the higher test voltages, it is capable of giving you a very nasty ‘bite’ should you become connected across the test clips or a charged high voltage capacitor. There are some situations where such a shock could potentially be lethal. Do NOT bypass the safety features included in this design. We don’t want to lose any SILICON CHIP readers to electrocution. 80  Silicon Chip siliconchip.com.au capacitor nd tester Most hobbyists would have collected many old electros over the years (maybe not as old as some of these!) – but are they any good, or can they be resurrected into life? which, together with a microswitch view the 2-line LCD which shows the of test voltages plus the inbuilt test interlock, provides a safe compartment capacitor voltage, its leakage current timer which allows the test voltage to for the capacitor when it has high volt- and the time elapsed. be applied for as long as 60 minutes. age applied. We also published an electrolytic Another compartment provides The design capacitor reformer designed by Rodhandy storage for the switchmode 12V This Electrolytic Capacitor Re- ney Champness in “Vintage Radio”, plugpack. former and Tester is based on the October 2006 issue. Opening the lid of the case means smaller and simpler unit described However, this new design not only that no voltage is applied to the in the December 2009 issue of SILICON offers higher voltages (the 2006 model capacitor – until the lid is closed – CHIP but with a much bigger selection only went to 400V), it is fully self but perhaps even contained, is a more more importantly, + elegant design and is RLY2 opening the lid very much safer to use. 16x2 LCD MODULE Q5 safely and quickly Commercial capacidischarges the cator leakage current pacitor so there meters/reformers are RA1 is no chance of available but they tend Q4 RA4 a nasty electric to be fairly expensive LED1 CAP UNDER TEST PIC16F88 shock – for you (well over $1000) and  MICRO or anyone else. we don’t believe any AMPLIFIER (IC3) +Vt AN2 A = 1.205 A charged 630V of them incorporate + – (IC2a) SELECTABLE capacitor with its a safety interlock to 100 DC VOLTAGE 1.770M AN5 leads exposed is avoid the possibility SOURCE RB7 RA4 RA7 (11 VOLTAGES, not something to of electric shock. 10V – 630V) be trifled with! With ours, you have RLY1 9.90k 6.8k With the transa choice of eleven dif(S1, IC1, Q1–Q3) S3 S4 S5 parent lid closed ferent standard test you can select the voltages: 10V, 16V, test voltage and 25V, 35V, 50V, 63V, the period of re- Fig.1: block diagram of the Electrolytic Capacitor Reformer and Tester. Not 100V, 250V, 400V, form/testing and shown here is the safety interlock microswitch and discharge resistors. 450V and 630V. These siliconchip.com.au August 2010  81 correspond with the rated voltages of most electrolytic capacitors which have been available for the last 30 years or so. If you have an “oddball” capacitor with a different working voltage, simply select the next voltage down. (In fact, in the vast majority of cases selecting the next voltage up won’t do the capacitor any harm either because most capacitors, especially electrolytics, can stand a short-term higher peak voltage than their working voltage, hence the labelling – eg, 400VW, 500VP). With any of these test voltages applied to a capacitor you can read its leakage current on the 2-line x 16-character backlit LCD screen, with two automatically selected current ranges: 0-200A or 0-20mA. As well, you can also read the voltage which appears across the capacitor at any time in the procedure. Importantly, for reforming capacitors you have the choice of ten test periods: 10 seconds, 30 seconds, 1 82  Silicon Chip minute, 3 minutes, 10 minutes, 30 minutes or 60 minutes. How it works Essentially the Reformer’s operation is quite straightforward, as you can see from the block diagram of Fig.1. This is broadly very similar to the abovementioned design in our December 2009 issue. There are only two functional circuit sections, one being a selectable DC voltage source (on the left) which generates one of 11 different preset test voltages when power is applied to the voltage source (actually a DC-DC converter) via relay RLY2, controlled by the PIC micro (IC3) via transistor Q4. This test voltage is applied to the positive terminal of the capacitor via a protective current limiting resistor and a microswitch, whose purpose we will look at shortly. The second functional circuit section is on the right in Fig.1 and combines a digital meter which is used to measure any direct current passed by the capacitor under test and the voltage appearing across the capacitor. There is also a digital timer which controls the DC test voltage source via Q4 and RLY2. The PIC micro (IC3) forms the ‘brains’ of this section. We use IC3 as a voltmeter to make the current measurement because any current passed by the capacitor flows down to ground via the 100Ω resistor, either alone or with the 9.90kΩ resistor in series. The resistor(s) therefore act as a current shunt and its voltage drop is directly proportional to the current flowing through the capacitor. The meter measures the voltage across the resistor(s) and is arranged to read directly in terms of current. We also use IC3 to measure the voltage across the capacitor for the duration of the leakage test or reforming period. That way, you can keep track of the leakage current and the voltage at any time. For a good capacitor, the voltage across it will rise while the leakage current steadily reduces. The reason for relay RLY1 and the siliconchip.com.au Inside the opened case, showing the main cut-out required. Inset top left is the interlock microswitch which cuts power and bleeds the charge on the capacitor when the lid is opened. And just in case you were wondering – yes, you do have to lay the capacitor down before closing the lid! Note this PC board is an early prototype – several changes have been made to the final version. 9.90kΩ resistor which it effectively switches in series with the 100Ω resistor is that this gives the digital current meter two ranges. This allows it to read leakage currents down to less than 100nA (0.1A), while also coping with charging and/or leakage currents of up to 20mA or thereabouts. Before the micro begins a test by turning on transistor Q4 and relay RLY2 to apply power to the test voltage source, it first turns on transistor Q5 and relay RLY1 to short out the 9.90kΩ resistor, giving the effective current shunt resistance a value of 100Ω, which gives a 0-20mA range for the capacitor’s charging phase. Only when (and if) the measured current level falls below 200A does it switch off Q5 and RLY1, increasing the total shunt resistance to 10kΩ and thus providing a 0-200A range for more accurate measurement of any residual leakage current. So that’s the basic arrangement. Pushbutton switches S3-S5 are used to select the test time period and also siliconchip.com.au to begin a test or end it prematurely. LED1 is used to indicate when RLY2 has applied power to the DC voltage source and therefore when the test voltage is present across the capacitor test terminals. The reason for the resistor in series with the output from the test voltage source is to limit the maximum current that can be drawn from the source in any circumstances. This prevents damage to either the voltage source or the digital metering sections in the event of the capacitor under test having an internal short circuit and also protects the 9.90kΩ shunt resistor and the digital voltmeter section from overload when a capacitor (especially one of high value) is initially charging up to one of the higher test voltages. In the full circuit you’ll find that this series resistance has a total value of 10.4kΩ, which was chosen to limit the maximum voltage which can ever appear at the input of the voltmeter’s input amplifier (IC2a) to just over 6V, even under short circuit conditions and with the highest test voltage of 630V. It is also used to limit the current when the instrument is being used for reforming electrolytics. Circuit description Now let’s have a look at the full circuit of Fig.2. The selectable DC voltage source is again on the left, based around IC1 – an MC34063 DC/ DC conversion controller IC. It used here in a step-up or ‘boost’ configuration in conjunction with driver transistors Q1 and Q2, switching transistor Q3, autotransformer T1 and fast switching diode D4. We vary the circuit’s DC output voltage by varying the ratio of the voltage divider in the converter’s feedback loop, connecting from the cathode of D4 back to IC1’s pin 5 (where the voltage is compared with an internal 1.25V reference). The four series-connected 75kΩ resistors, together with trimpot VR1, form the top arm of the feedback dividAugust 2010  83 12V DC INPUT FROM PLUGPACK POWER D5 1N4004 + REG1 7805 +11.4V K A IN S2 1000 F 25V – RLY2 1000 F 25V +5V OUT GND 220 F K D6 1N4004 A TEST VOLTS ON RLY2: 6V MINI DIL RELAY (JAYCAR SY-4058 OR SIMILAR) A +11.4V  LED1 K 47 D4 UF4007 A 0.27  1k 5W Vcc DrC Ct IC1 MC34063 SwE GND 4 1nF 1 C Q1 BC337 E 100 B 2 B 2.2k C Q3 IRF540N 470nF 630V S Q2 BC327 110  1% 100k 390k 75k 1% 100k 75k 1% 100k 47 F 450V VR1 50k (25T) 100k 1% ZD2 4.7V TPG 16  1% 390k 47 F 450V K TP3 SET VOLTS A 33  1% 220  1% 100k 75k 1% 390k +1.25V 560  1% 75k 1% D G E Cin5 390k 470nF 630V 10T 8 SwC 3 8.2k 5W +HV 80T 7 Ips 6 K T1 560  1% 30  1% 2.4k 1% 3.0k 1% 100 1% 2.0k 1% 4.7k 1% 150 1% 6.8k 1% 1k 1% 22k 1% 63V 50V 100V 250V 400V 450V 630V SC 2010 S1 35V 25V 16V 10V SET TEST VOLTS ELECTROLYTIC CAPACITOR RE-FORMER & LEAKAGE METER er, while the 100kΩ resistor from pin 5 to ground forms the fixed component of the lower arm. These give the voltage source its lowest output voltage of close to 10.5V, which is the converter’s output voltage when selector switch S1 is in the ‘10V’ position. When S1 is switched to any of the other positions additional resistors are connected in parallel with the lower arm of the feedback divider, to increase its division ratio and hence increase the converter’s output voltage. For example, when S1 is in the ‘16V’ position, all of the series-connected resistors in the string between the various positions of S1 are in parallel with the 100kΩ 84  Silicon Chip resistor, increasing the division ratio to increase the converter’s regulated output voltage to 16.25V. The same kind of change occurs in all of the other positions of S1, producing the various preset output voltages shown. Although the test voltages shown are nominal, if you use the specified 1% tolerance resistors for all of the divider resistors they should all be within ±4% of the nominal values, because the 1.25V reference inside the MC34063 is accurate to within 2%. IC1 operates only when the 11.4V supply rail is connected to it via relay RLY2, under the control of micro IC3. The converter circuit then operates and generates the desired test voltage across the two 470nF/630V metallised polyester reservoir capacitors, connected in series, with their voltage-sharing resistors in parallel. At the same time LED1 is illuminated, to warn you that the test voltage will be present at the test terminals. Note that the test voltage present at the top of the feedback divider is not fed directly to the positive test connector, but is first fed through a low-pass RC filter formed by the 8.2kΩ 5W resistor and the series-connected 47F/450V capacitors (which again have voltagesharing resistors in parallel). This filter is to smooth out any ripsiliconchip.com.au +5V 47 F 2.2k 100nF Q4 BC337 Q5 BC327 C E 2.2k B C B 2.2k 5W 12 10k NO MICRO SWITCH ON S6 CASE LID COM 1k 1W 10k S3 S5 TEST TERMINALS D2 + IC4 LM336Z 2.5 TPG ADJ – RB5 2 100 8 1 IC2a 1 RB3 AN2 RB2 RB1 560 K 10k K RB0 A = 1.205 11 4 10 6 56 CLKo EN K K A ZD1,ZD2 A K A B-L K 16 8 7 IC2: LM358 6 15 TP2 (2.0MHz) 6 – + ADJ IRF540N BC327, BC337 B E 7 7805 D GND IN G C IC2b 4 TPG LM336-2.5 LED K A R/W 5 9 Vss 5 3.0k 1N4004, UF4007 3 CONTRAST RS RLY1: 5V/10mA (JAYCAR SY-4030 OR SIMILAR) D1-D3: 1N4148 15 B-L A A A 2 2 Vdd 5 D1 7,8 22 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 GND 1 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 10nF LCD CONTRAST VR3 10k 16 x 2 LCD MODULE RB4 3 ZD1 6.2V 1W VR2 10k IC3 PIC16F88 DECR TIME 1k 6 A K – 1,14 +5V K D3 100nF RLY1 SET 2.49V REFERENCE A TP1 AN5 16 RA7 17 RA0 13 RB7 INCR TIME TEST + +2.49V RA4 10k S4 100nF 4 14 Vdd MCLR RA1 2 Vref+ 6.8k 680k NC 1M 3 270k 820k 1k 1W 18 4.7k E 2.4k 100nF 10k D S GND OUT Fig.2: similar to the block diagram, the circuit is divided into two distinct sections – the high voltage generation on the left side and the reforming/reading/metering section on the right, which itself is under the control of a PIC microcontroller. Don’t depart from this circuit diagram – a lot of effort has gone into making it safe! ple present in the output of the voltage source/converter. The filtered test voltage is then made available at the positive test terminal via a 2.2kΩ 5W series resistor, which together with the 8.2kΩ 5W series resistance of the filter forms the protective current limiting resistance shown in Fig.1. Charged electros can be lethal! Before the test voltage is fed to the capacitor’s positive test connector, it first has to pass through microswitch S6, which is attached to the case so that it switches when the case lid is opened. Normally, (ie with the lid closed) the test voltage is connected but when siliconchip.com.au the lid is opened, the test capacitor’s positive terminal is connected to its negative terminal via two 1kΩ, 1W resistors which will discharge even the largest high voltage capacitors normally encountered in less than a second. Two 1W resistors are used to obtain a sufficiently high voltage rating for the highest value test setting. Of course, very high value lowervoltage capacitors will take much longer to discharge (as much as a few seconds or so) but these are not considered as dangerous to life and limb. It is important for your safety (and more importantly, the safety of others) that the microswitch is not left out nor bypassed or worse, the circuit built into a case which does not have a hinged lid allowing this form of protection. The circuit is perfectly safe as described. Wiring external to the PC board (ie, the high voltage wiring) should be made with 250V AC-rated cable. The easiest place to get such cable is from a surplus flexible mains lead. In fact, you might be lucky enough to find that you have some with red and black insulated wires (which are needed for the test capacitor connections) and newer ones with brown and blue insulated wires (ideal for the connections between PC board and microswitch). We wouldn’t use the green or green/yellow wiring August 2010  85 Parts List –Electrolytic Reformer & Tester 1 Trojan TJW0510 38cm Storage Organiser (from Bunnings) 1 PC board, code 04108101, 210 x 120mm 1 Front panel label, 320 x 120mm, laminated 1 16x2 LCD module with backlighting (Jaycar QP-5516 or Altronics Z-7013) 1 Mini DIL reed relay, SPST with 5V coil 1 Mini DIL relay, SPDT with 6V coil 1 SPDT 250V 10A microswitch (Jaycar SM-1040 or equivalent) 2 19mm square TO-220 heatsinks 1 Ferrite pot core pair, 26mm OD with bobbin to suit 1 25mm long M3 Nylon screw with nut and flat washer 1 1m length of 0.8mm diameter enamelled copper wire 1 10m length of 0.25mm diameter enamelled copper wire 1 Single pole 12-position rotary switch (S1) 1 Instrument knob, 16mm with grub screw fixing 1 SPDT mini toggle switch, panel mtg (S2) 3 SP Momentary pushbutton switches, panel mtg (S3-5) 18 6mm long M3 machine screws, pan head 4 25mm long M3 tapped spacers 4 12mm long M3 tapped Nylon spacers (or two - see text) 3 Nylon flat washers (only for QP-5516 module - see text) 2 M3 nuts 1 7x2 length DIL socket strip, OR 16-way length SIL socket strip (see text) 1 7x2 length DIL pin strip, OR 16-way length SIL pin strip (see text) 1 18-pin IC socket 2 8-pin IC sockets 10 PC board terminal pins, 1mm diameter 2 100mm long Nylon cable ties Semiconductors 1 MC34063 DC/DC converter controller (IC1) 1 LM358 dual op amp (IC2) 1 PIC16F88 microcontroller (IC3, programmed with 0410810A firmware) 1 LM336Z 2.5V reference (IC4) 1 7805 +5V regulator (REG1) 2 BC337 NPN transistor (Q1,Q4) 2 BC327 PNP transistor (Q2,Q5) 1 IRF540N 100V/33A MOSFET (Q3) 1 6.2V zener diode (ZD1) 1 4.7V zener diode (ZD2) 1 5mm red LED (LED1) 3 1N4148 100mA diode (D1,D2,D3) 1 UF4007 ultrafast 1000V/1A diode (D4) 2 1N4004 400V/1A diode (D5,D6) Capacitors 2 1000F 25V RB electrolytic 1 220F 16V RB electrolytic 1 47F 16V RB electrolytic 2 47F 450V RB electrolytic 2 470nF 630V metallised polyester 2 100nF MKT metallised polester 2 100nF multilayer monolithic ceramic 1 10nF MKT metallised polyester 1 1nF disc ceramic Resistors (0.25W 1% metal film unless specified) 1 1MΩ 1 820kΩ 1 680kΩ 4 5 100kΩ 4 75kΩ 1 22kΩ 1 2 6.8kΩ 2 4.7kΩ 2 3.0kΩ 1 3 2.2kΩ 1 2.0kΩ 2 1kΩ 1W 3 1 220Ω 1 150Ω 1 110Ω 2 1 47Ω 1 33Ω 1 30Ω 1 1 0.27Ω 5W 1 50kΩ 25T vertical trimpot (VR1) 2 10kΩ mini horizontal trimpot (VR2,VR3) 86  Silicon Chip 390kΩ 8.2kΩ 5W 2.2kΩ 5W 1kΩ 100Ω 22Ω 1 5 2 3 1 1 270kΩ 10kΩ 2.4kΩ 560Ω 56Ω 16Ω for ANY purpose except earth wiring. Some readers may query the use of 250V-rated cable when the highest voltage check is clearly well above this figure – 630V to be precise. The justification is that Australian/New Zealand standard AS/NZ3017 calls for mains power wiring to be tested at 1000V DC so it follows that the insulation of 250V cable must be able to handle this, at least in the short term. Voltage & current metering Now let us look at the digital metering and control section, which is virtually all of the circuitry below and to the right of the negative test terminal. The 100Ω resistor and paralleled 1MΩ and 10kΩ resistors connected between the negative test terminal and ground correspond to the current shunts shown in Fig.1, with the contacts of reed relay RLY1 used to change the effective shunt resistance for the meter’s two ranges. For the 20mA ‘charging phase’ range RLY1 is energised via Q5 and connects a short circuit across the parallel 1MΩ/10kΩ combination, making the effective shunt resistance 100. But for the more sensitive 200A range RLY1 is turned off, opening its contacts and connecting the parallel 1MΩ/10kΩ resistors in series with the 100Ω resistor to produce an effective shunt resistance of 10kΩ. As you can see the voltage drop across the shunt resistance (as a result of any current passed by the capacitor under test) is passed to the non-inverting input of IC2a, one half of an LM358 dual op amp. And IC2a is configured as a DC amplifier with a voltage gain of 1.205 times, feeding the AN2 analog input of IC3, the PIC16F88 microcontroller which forms the ‘heart’ of the metering/control section. IC3 takes its measurements of the amplified current shunt voltage from IC2a by comparing this voltage with a reference voltage of 2.490V fed into pin 2 of IC3. The reference voltage is derived from the regulated +5V supply line via voltage reference IC4, an LM336Z device which is provided with a voltage trim circuit using D2, D3 and VR2. These are used to set its voltage drop to exactly 2.490V, where it displays a near-zero temperature coefficient. In fact IC3 takes a sequence of 10 measurements at a time and calculates the average of the 10 readings to reduce ‘jitter’ caused by noise transients. siliconchip.com.au This early prototype board has had several component and design changes to that shown in the circuit diagram on p84-85. The final version, along with the component overlay, will be shown next month in the constructional article. It then does mathematical scaling to arrive at the equivalent current readings, which it displays on the 16x2 LCD module. IC3 also monitors the voltage across the capacitor via a voltage divider feeding its AN5 input, pin 12. Timer function As mentioned earlier, pushbutton switches S3-S5 are used to select the test time period to be used and also to begin testing a capacitor. Switch S4 is used to increase the test period time, while S5 is used to decrease it. Then when the user has set S1 for the correct test voltage and has selected the test time period using S4 and S5, testing is begun by pressing S3. IC3 then turns on Q5 and RLY1 to set the metering circuit for the 10mA range, after which it turns on Q4 and RLY2 to feed power to the test voltage converter (and LED1). It also starts a software timer to control how long the test voltage is to be applied. While the test is being carried out, the metering section takes voltage and current readings and displays these on the LCD module, changing down to the 0-200A range automatically if siliconchip.com.au the measurements drop below 0.2mA. Then when the selected test time period ends or the user presses S3 again to end the test prematurely, IC3 switches off the test voltage source. The voltage and current measurements continue however, so you can monitor the current decay as the test voltage drops to zero. Zener diode ZD1 is included in the metering circuit to protect the pin 3 input of IC2a from damage due to accidental application of a negative or high positive voltage to the negative test terminal (from a previously charged capacitor, for example). On the other hand diode D1 is included to protect transistor Q5 from damage due to any back EMF ‘spike’ from the coil of RLY1 when it is de-energised. Trimpot VR3 allows the contrast of the LCD module to be adjusted for optimum visibility. The 22Ω resistor connecting from the +5V supply rail to pin 15 of the LCD module is to provide current for the module’s LED back-lighting. IC1 and the selectable DC voltage source operates directly from the 12V DC supply line (via polarity protection diode D5 and of course power switch S2) while the rest of the circuit operates from a regulated 5V rail which is derived from the battery via REG1, a standard 7805 3-terminal regulator. That’s basically it. The only other point which should perhaps be mentioned is that the PIC16F88 micro (IC3) operates here from its internal RC clock, at a frequency very close to 8MHz. A clock signal of one quarter this frequency (ie, 2MHz) is made available at pin 15 of IC3 and is brought out to test point TP2, to allow you to check that IC3 is operating correctly. Construction Now that we have the design and operation under our belts, we’re ready to move onto the construction. Unfortunately, though, space has beaten us this month, so the complete constructional details, including the mounting of the project within the special case, will be presented next month. In the meantime, the parts list is shown opposite so you can start collecting the bits required. Firmware for the PIC micro will also be on the SILICON CHIP website (siliconchip.com. SC au) next month. August 2010  87 Vintage Radio By RODNEY CHAMPNESS, VK3UG The Airzone 612 6-valve battery-powered console H ISTORICALLY, most urban dwellers have not been interested in listening to radio stations outside the city they live in. As a result, radio manufacturers made a point of producing small 4-valve mantel receivers for the mass market. They were typically used in kitchens and bedrooms and were marketed alongside the more expensive 5-valve (or more) mantel and console receivers that were popular from the 1930s to the 1950s. These little 4-valve sets and their larger siblings were mostly mains-operated and were usually quite simple in design. However, their performance was quite adequate for most city users, who tended to use them for background entertainment rather than for serious listening. It’s fair to say that the production of 4-valve sets, along with more ambitious receivers in classy cabinets, was the mainstay of radio manufacturing during the valve era. Rural listeners Designed in 1938, the Airzone 612 was a 6-valve battery-operated receiver specifically designed for use in remote areas. It’s an excellent performer and even after 70 years, the alignment of the set featured here was almost spot on. 88  Silicon Chip Although such sets performed well in city areas, where there were lots of local stations, they were often unsuitable for use in remote rural locations. Many people at that time had no access to mains power, which meant that the sets had to be battery-powered or designed to run from 32V DC lighting plants. This in turn meant that power consumption had to minimised. Sets designed for use in rural areas also had to be more sensitive. AM radio stations back in the 1930s were not particularly powerful and were often even less so in country areas. That’s because commercial broadcast stations were allowed to operate with transmitter output powers of 5kW in capital cities but only 2kW in country areas. siliconchip.com.au As expected, country stations were located only in those areas where there was enough advertising revenue to make them viable. This meant that many areas had no stations within hundreds of kilometres. Where I lived as a youngster, the nearest station was 3WV which was 145km away, while the next nearest station was about 180km distant. And we didn’t live in the outback by any means! As a result, for many people in rural areas, large outdoor antennas and sensitive receivers were needed to pick up a reasonable selection of radio stations. Fortunately, ABC national stations were allowed to broadcast at higher powers than the commercial stations and so many ABC country stations used 10kW transmitters. Against this background, some manufacturers marketed sets that were specifically designed for rural listeners. One such set was the Airzone 612, a 6-valve battery-powered console receiver. The Airzone 612 6-valve set The Airzone 612 console from 1938 was an impressive receiver, both as an attractive-looking console and as a sensitive battery-operated set for remote country areas. Airzone had been making good receivers right from the beginning of the 1930s and this model really performs well. As mentioned earlier, receivers designed for the more remote regions of Australia needed to be quite sensitive. They also needed to have good selectivity and to use as little power as possible. Most receivers of that era used large 45V batteries plus a 2V lead-acid cell to power them. Usually, three 45V batteries were used, to give a high-tension (HT) voltage of 135V. These 45V dry batteries were expensive but with frugal use, would last about one year. Battery-powered sets were not just turned on and let run all day, as became the habit of those with mainsoperated receivers. Instead, they were turned on for particular programs and then turned off again to conserve the batteries. The lead-acid 2V cell would require recharging every month or so and this was usually done at a local garage or radio service shop. However, some owners did work out other ways to recharge this cell, sometimes with disastrous results! In the Airzone 612, the current siliconchip.com.au This is the view inside the old Airzone 612 console. A large loudspeaker and a decent baffle ensured good sound levels despite the output stage delivering a maximum output power of just 350mW. drain from the 2V cell is just 0.54A because the valves used mostly have low filament currents. These low-drain valves did not cause any noticeable reduction in performance. By contrast, most battery-operated sets of the era drew around 0.72A of filament current, despite the fact that they only used five valves. The battery drain on the HT line is 18mA on shortwave and 17mA on the broadcast band. This is a little higher than for many other sets of the era but the Airzone 612 does have six valves compared to five in most other batteryoperated sets. Circuit details Refer now to Fig.1 for the circuit details of the Airzone 612. The receiver is quite conventional with a 1D5G (V1) as a tuned RF (radio frequency) amplifier. The output from this stage is coupled via another tuned circuit to the signal grid of a 1C7G (V2) which functions as the frequency converter. This stage generates an IF signal that’s 456kHz higher than the tuned RF signal. This IF signal is coupled via a double-tuned IF transformer to a 1D5G (V3) which functions as the first IF amplifier. The resulting signal is then fed via another double-tuned IF transformer to the second IF amplifier (V4). It then goes through another doubletuned IF transformer to the detection and AGC diodes in a 1K7G valve (V5). Finally, the detected audio signal is fed to the pentode section of a 1F5G (V6) which in turn drives a large (and efficient) loudspeaker via an output transformer. The Airzone 612 is not just limited to the broadcast band, however. This is a dual-wave receiver and it also has provision for amplifying the output from a turntable pick-up. It features three tuned circuits for the broadcast band and another three for the shortAugust 2010  89 V1 V2 V3 V4 V5 V6 Fig.1: the Airzone 612 is a fairly conventional superhet design employing six valves. It’s a dual-band set and was powered from a 2V lead-acid cell (for the valve filaments) and three 45V batteries (to derive a 135V HT supply). wave band, these being an antenna tuned circuit, an RF tuned circuit and an oscillator tuned circuit (for the converter stage). The wave-change switch has three positions: phono (record player), shortwave band and broadcast band. This is a 9-section switch, with seven sections involved in switching from broadcast to shortwave. Another section switches the dial lamps so that either the shortwave or the broadcast dial markings are illuminated, while the remaining section alters the screen voltage to IF amplifiers V3 and V4 so that the gain on the broadcast band is less than on shortwave. When the switch is in the phono position, it removes the screen voltage from the IF valves (V3 & V4) to disable them in this mode. Another 3-position switch provides a 1-step tone control and controls the dial lamps. In sets such as this, the dial lamps were only switched on to aid tuning and were then switched off to reduce the load on the 2V cell. Bias & AGC The detector diode in V5 has no bias applied to it and commences working as soon as a signal is received. By contrast, the AGC diode is biased to -2V which means that it doesn’t start conducting until the IF signal exceeds 2V. This means the set has delayed AGC which is very useful when operating in weak signal areas. Standing bias is applied to the four RF and IF valves and this is derived from the voltage developed across R19 in the HT- line. In addition, the AGC line applies various amounts of bias to valves V1-V3, depending on the signal strength. The RF valve (V1) receives the full AGC voltage (via R11), while V2 & V3 receive just half the AGC voltage (derived from the junction of resistors R13 and R14). V4 (the 2nd IF amplifier) has no AGC applied to it. Here’s looking at you A close-up view of the dial scale. The dial lamps are switched so that only the broadcast or shortwave markings are illuminated. 90  Silicon Chip Some console receivers of the era looked like they had cabinets made out of wooden packing-cases. Not so the Airzone 612 – its stylish cabinet is well-built by any standard. It features a round escutcheon with the dial-scale in the centre, while the four control knobs are placed along the lower, outer rim of the escutcheon. This differs from most other receivers which had their controls arranged in a straight line along the chassis. The clear dial cover in the escutch- eon is now showing its age, having yellowed somewhat. However, because it’s curved, a replacement is difficult to source. The chassis and cabinet interior required very little cleaning and as can be seen, the labelling on the chassis is almost as good as the day it was made. By contrast, the cabinet has suffered a number of knocks over the years and requires a lot of work to make it look new again. Restoring the circuit Considering it age, the chassis was really in quite good condition although there were inevitably a few problems. First, when it was removed from the cabinet, it was found that the volume control had been replaced at some time in the past and its shaft had been cut quite short. As a result, it was missing its control knob. An under-chassis inspection also revealed a degree of tampering by someone who clearly didn’t know what they were doing. This is a common problem with many vintage radios – the “hero” who is going to restore it attacks it with great gusto, in the process removing many parts which are earmarked for later replacement. Unfortunately, he subsequently cannot remember where everything goes and so parts finish up where they don’t belong and the set doesn’t work properly. Finally, after lots of mucking about, our “hero” gives up and sells the set as “a going concern” (which it isn’t) to another collector. It’s a scenario I’ve encountered all too often. Fortunately, this receiver had since come into the hands of a friend of mine siliconchip.com.au (Marcus) who is capable of restoring old radios. His practice is to replace all the paper and electrolytic capacitors when restoring a receiver and so this was one of his first jobs. Marcus also tested all the valves and found that the 1K7G was faulty. This was replaced, after which further checks were made on component values. During this process, Marcus discovered that the 1K7G’s plate resistor (R24) had been changed from 250kΩ to 20kΩ. The original 250kΩ resistor had been wired to the grid instead of the plate, so it was no wonder the valve was faulty. Valves do not take kindly to significant positive voltages on their control grids. Another problem concerned backbias resistors R19 & R20. These are actually part of a single tapped wirewound resistor which is bolted to the chassis. This was faulty, again due to the previous restorer, and was replaced with two separate resistors. Next, the various moving controls and sliding surfaces were oiled and the dial system checked over. The dial mechanism has a flywheel drive which is good for rapidly tuning from one end of the band to the other. Many sets had this function in the 1930s and 1940s and I’ve usually found them easy to use. Marcus’ next task was to obtain a 230V AC to 2V DC and 135V DC power supply. Fortunately, suitable kits are available commercially and so one of these was assembled and tested. (Note: a design using readily-available parts and with various output voltages will be described in a future Vintage Radio column). Having completed the power supply, Marcus connected an antenna and an earth (via a 10nF capacitor to chassis) and switched the set on. The result was complete silence, despite the fact that most of the critical parts had been checked and the obvious faults fixed. It didn’t take long to track down the problem. A close inspection soon revealed that the speaker transformer had been replaced at some stage and the speaker cone had also been damaged. Unfortunately though, the flexible wires that connect the voice coil to the speaker transformer had been broken. This fault was quickly repaired using some flexible wire from a defunct loudspeaker, while the hole in the siliconchip.com.au The old Airzone’s chassis was in remarkably good condition for its age, with all the labelling still intact. Unfortunately, someone had tampered with the circuitry, although the problems were soon sorted out. speaker cone was repaired by gluing a thick paper covering in place. This was the original speaker, so it was worth spending the time to repair it. Marcus was not happy about the speaker transformer being mounted directly on the speaker, however. The reason for this was simple – if anyone was to remove the speaker plug on the back of the chassis while the receiver was operating, the 1F5G output valve would have no voltage on its plate but full voltage on its screen. It would not survive this sort of treatment for long and so, despite detracting from originality, Marcus decided to mount the transformer on the chassis, with only the voice-coil 1F5-G CHASSIS SPEAKER SOCKET leads going to the speaker via the plug. In fact, it would not have been difficult for Airzone to have corrected this problem. They could have easily wired the receiver so that the HT to the entire circuit was removed if the speaker was unplugged, thus saving the 1F5G from destruction. As shown in Fig.2, the modification is so simple that it makes one wonder why Airzone didn’t do this. It still didn’t work The set was tested again following the loudspeaker repairs but it still refused to work. As a result, the voltages around each stage were checked and this revealed that V1’s plate had no SPEAKER PLUG SPEAKER C22 SPEAKER TRANSFORMER HT TO OTHER VALVES HT+ Fig.2: this circuit shows how the unit could have been wired so that the HT to the valves was removed if the speaker assembly was unplugged. August 2010  91 The original loudspeaker required some work to get it going again, including a patch on the paper cone. The flexible wires that connect the voice coil to the speaker transformer had also been damaged and required replacement. voltage on it. Once again, the cause was simple – an RF (radio frequency) choke in the plate circuit had gone open circuit. Just why there’s an RF choke in this location is a mystery and the circuit certainly doesn’t show one. My theory is that it may have been added to overcome some instability. It was replaced with a small resistor-style RF choke but the receiver still refused to work. It was then found that the earlier “restorer” had wired gangs two and three together at the switch. Once that had been corrected, the receiver came to life and it was possible to tune stations at good volume. A quick check revealed that the IF alignment was close to optimum, as was the alignment of the front-end stages around valves V1 and V2. This is a tribute to the quality of the components used by Airzone in this receiver. All that was left to do was to replace The Fifth National Radio & Phono Fest By KEVIN POULTER In a departure from our usual Photo Gallery feature, this month we are publicising a huge vintage radio and phonograph event. Scheduled for September, it will feature a vast range of collectibles for sale and free workshops. This can be a great opportunity to start or expand your collection, see the best collectables and learn restoration techniques. There is no bigger event in Australia for these collectables. Vintage radio is so popular that this national event is now staged every two years in the nation’s capital. Titled the “HRSA Radio Fest” (previously called the “National Radio and Phono Fest”), it attracts big 92  Silicon Chip crowds of HRSA (Historical Radio Society of Australia) members plus members of affiliated groups and an enthusiastic public to Canberra each spring. In the beginning . . . RadioFest began in late 2000 when Richard Begbie, a relatively new member of the HRSA, attended their meeting in Sydney. He suggested that with the cooperation of similar groups around the country, there might be room for something bigger – a national event. And so the first “National Radio and Phono Fest” was organised for September 2001. A church hall was hired but it soon some defunct dial lamps and fix the volume control. A switch-potentiometer was used for the original volume control and as the on/off switch. However, because the new power supply had its own on/off switch, Marcus decided to fit an ordinary potentiometer instead. The shaft on this replacement unit was still too short and so an extension had to be fitted. A brass extension shaft was scrounged from his spare parts bin while a sleeve to join the two was made from some 16mm-diameter round aluminium bar. This was turned down in a lathe and drilled through with a 0.25-inch hole. Finally, two holes were drilled and tapped along one side to accept the grub screws. At this stage, the technical restoration was complete and the set has now been returned to its owner so that the cabinet can be restored to its former glory. Summary This set’s performance is superb, with distant stations like 5CK (about 750km away from my location in country Victoria) being heard in daylight at a reasonable level. It only has around 350mW of audio output but this is more than adequate due to the efficiency of its loudspeaker and the use of a decent baffle in the large cabinet. In summary, it’s a set that’s wellSC worth having in any collection. became apparent that it wouldn’t be big enough. An adjoining hall was also taken over and by the time the RadioFest doors opened to the public, both halls were jammed with gear for sale. Stallholders and visitors from as far away as Japan were equally enthusiastic about the day and everyone – with the possible exception of the stunned organiser – declared it must happen again. Of course, its ongoing appeal also has much to do with Canberra’s other attractions like the War Memorial, the Film and Sound Archive, the National Museum and the beginning of the capital’s annual garden festival. If you get sick of looking at dusty valve technology, there are lots of other things to see and do. RadioFest offers much more than the usual swap meet. Beyond the large trading halls, there are also workshops by experts on technical, mechanical and restoration matters. A dinner on the Saturday night siliconchip.com.au RadioFest Program • provides the chance for radio enthusiasts to get together and share their knowledge and experience. Because of ongoing space demands, the show was soon moved to University House in the grounds of the ANU (Australian National University) and has since continued to expand. The dinner became a highlight for many, while others eagerly stocked up on rare vintage parts, early phonographs, intriguing radios which tell the story of broadcast radio and must-have sets of the type seen regularly on TV collectors’ programs. In addition, films are made of the various workshops and distributed to enthusiasts around the country. This year it’s on again and the anticipated crowd sizes have dictated yet another siliconchip.com.au change in venue, this time to the Kamberra Wine Centre (yes, the spelling is correct) over the weekend from 18-19th September. Moreover, the HRSA has officially taken over the event for what promises to be a bumper Fest. An added feature this year will be a display of some of the best early radio collectables, including many unique items in Australian radio history. Richard Begbie said the national event had become a huge logistical effort and welcomed the HRSA’s involvement in the organising. “I am delighted that the HRSA has taken over this event”, he told me. “The Society is its natural home and it’s the kind of thing they’ll do well. And besides – there’ll be more people to do the work!” Mike Osborne, president of the HRSA agrees. “I’ve watched the Canberra Fest grow from its beginnings and have personally enjoyed every aspect of its development. It’s a great step forward for the society to be taking responsibility for a national event”. The Kamberra Wine Centre, Federal Highway, Watson ACT is a terrific venue, with good access from the Federal and Barton Highways. If you want to know more, visit the HRSA’s website at www. hrsa.asn.au and click on “RadioFest” for the location map and dates. So how do you secure a place at this outstanding event? If you have something to sell, stall tables are fast running out with just one size left – 1800 x 760mm (6ft x 2.5ft). These are available for $25 each. Stall tables are available to HRSA members and affiliated groups only, however there is still time to Sit-down dinner, Saturday 7pm – great entertainment, including a guest speaker. Preview display over pre-dinner drinks. • Bumper market from 9am Sunday – parts, radios, ephemera. • Genuinely unique historic items in multiple displays. • Professionally-presented workshops, including: (1) The History & Mystery of the Valve. (2) J. G. Balsillie – The Forgotten Australian Radio Pioneer. (3) Timber Cabinets – When And How To Restore. • The HRSA Annual General Meeting (members only) – to be held on Sunday night, with members from all over Australia. join the HRSA, for $35 per year. This fee includes the “Radio Waves” magazine. For stall bookings, contact Richard Elliott on (02) 4846 1096 or email him on lambdas<at> optusnet.com.au The Sunday entry to the event is $5 per person or $10 for a family (stallholders exempt). The dinner function is $40 per person or $75 per couple. The bar opens from 6:15pm. For bookings, contact John Carr on (02) 6226 3230 or Richard Elliott on (02) 4846 1096; email lambdas<at> optusnet.com.au Accommodation options range from camping grounds to five star. For details, including distance from venue, contact Richard Elliott. Other queries can be directed to Richard Begbie on (02) 6238 2246; email rb<at>bordernet.com.au SC August 2010  93 ASK SILICON CHIP Got a technical problem? Can’t understand a piece of jargon or some technical principle? Drop us a line and we’ll answer your question. Write to: Ask Silicon Chip, PO Box 139, Collaroy Beach, NSW 2097 or send an email to silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au PC-controlled burglar alarm I have a problem with the PC-Controlled Burglar Alarm. When I am in the arm/disarm menu or in the comms set-up menu, the red LEDs are always off no matter what changes I make to the program. The buttons concerning the strike doors work but the red LEDs remain off whether I arm or disarm the corresponding zone. The PC Tx/Rx LED works fine; it flashes at varying speeds. I use a laptop with a USB-to-serial interface. Can you please help. (I. P., via email). • Check the connection between pins 5 & 6 of IC1 to pins 11 & 10 of IC4. Check that IC4 has a +5V supply at pin 16 and 0V at pin 8. Check that the LEDs are oriented correctly. Check the connection from pin 7 of IC1 to the base of Q6 via the 1.2kΩ resistor. Make sure there is a 100kΩ resistor from pin 6 of IC1 to the 5V supply. Using a 3G modem with the WIB I have been rather interested in the well-written and explained article on the mysteries that revolve around the Web Server In a Box project. Could this WIB be used somehow with the 3G wireless modems, like the Huawei 169 USB unit, for example? At present, my 3G modem is through Optus which links to Virgin Blue. I hope you can help me. By the way, this is a great project that could help with remote data-logging and do it in a way that is very economical. I have been waiting for years for someone to do this. (A. M., Warrnambool, Vic). • You will need a modem with an ethernet rather than a USB connection to use with the WIB. To be able to use a USB modem, you would need a USB host and the WIB has no hardware support for a USB host as it stands. However, there are 3G wireless modems which have an ethernet connection and these should work with the WIB. Class-A 20W amplifier question For my active speaker project, I need to build two 20W class-A stereo amplifiers without the preamps (SILICON CHIP, May 2007). Unfortunately, Altronics does not supply the shielded 16V+16V, 160VA toroid transformer separately from the kit (K5125). Could you please indicate if I can use an 18V+18V 160VA toroid, or should I use a 15V+15V 160VA toroid? I will relocate the transformer to a separate enclosure to stop the electromagnetic field from affecting the performance of amplifier modules. (D. H., via email). • Assuming you cannot purchase the specified shielded 160VA transformer, your next best approach may be to buy a 300VA 15V+15V toroidal transformer and as you suggest, house it in a separate box. Since the load on the transformer will be less than 100W for the two 20W modules, its output voltage is likely to be close to 16V+16V and therefore the amplifier operating conditions should be much the same. The bigger transformer should also have less tendency to buzz audibly at the reduced load although it will still radiate the same magnetic field intensity. Replacing the amplifier modules in an ETI 5000 I am about to build two Ultra-LD Mk.2 amplifier kits (SILICON CHIP, August & September 2008) and two new power supply boards. These will replace my ETI 5000 amplifiers and power supply in the same 3-unit case. Troubleshooting The High-Quality Stereo DAC Project I’ve completed the input board of the Stereo DAC (SILICON CHIP, September, October & November 2009) and it does not recognise when digital data is being sent through optical or coaxial cable. After I plug in the optical cable and there is no data transmitted, the yellow LED is on. After I start playing anything, the green LED should turn on but it doesn’t. I’ve checked whether I have all the parts where they should be and I do not see any problem. Can you please advise how to debug this problem? (R. D., via email). • The first step is to measure the 94  Silicon Chip voltage at pin 15 of IC4 (ATMEGA­48/V) relative to ground (pin 22). If a valid signal is present, it should read close to 0V. If it is around 5V, this means that IC3 (DIR9001) is not receiving a signal. In that case, you should check IC3’s power supply (ie, the 3.3V rail) and ensure that it is operating correctly. If you have an oscilloscope or a frequency counter, monitor pin 13 of IC2 and make sure it is delivering a 3-8MHz square-wave pulse train. If pin 15 of IC4 reads 0V but still no LEDs are lit, then the problem may be with IC4. It could be incorrectly programmed or defective. Check the voltage at pins 5 & 6 of IC4 relative to ground (pin 8). If there is a valid signal present but no audio, pin 5 should read 5V and pin 6 should be at 0V. If there is a valid signal and audio, pin 5 should be at 0V and pin 6 at 5V. If both are at 0V and pin 15 is at 0V, then the ATMEGA48 is not programmed correctly or faulty. If you get a reading near 5V at either pin 5 or pin 6 but the yellow and green LEDs are not lit, the ribbon cable connecting the input board to the front panel is probably faulty. Either that or the LEDs are installed backwards. siliconchip.com.au However if possible, I would like to use the original transformers, except that their secondary voltage is 42V0-42V AC, as opposed to the 40V-0-40V as recommended for the Ultra-LD amplifier. Would the extra DC voltage be a problem and would it affect the specification of the amplifier. (L. W., Bega, NSW). • The slightly higher transformer voltage should cause no problems and will lead to a slight increase in maximum power output. Digital sampling of IR remote controls I am wanting to monitor and study the output of some infrared remote controls using the IR Remote Control Tester (SILICON CHIP, January 2009) and an oscilloscope. Unfortunately, my analog scope is hopeless due to the random nature of the output of a lot of remote controls. Obviously, a digital scope is required but I was wondering if there is a cheaper method. I was thinking that maybe a multimeter with a data logging computer interface, such as those sold by Jaycar Transistor Voltage Ratings In SC480 Amplifier I know that the SC480 amplifier (SILICON CHIP, January & February 2003) is an old design but I’m wondering about the reliability of using the 2N3055/2N2995 devices with a ±40V supply as these transistors have a VCEO of only 60V. The full rail voltage swing of around 70V or 80V would be seen by the output transistors. I have had two failures of the output transistors over the last year and not under full power conditions and suspect they failed due to the VCEO rating of the transistors being exceeded. The TIP35/36C transistors would not have this problem since their VCEO is 100V. (D. D., via email). • You are the first reader to comor Altronics, would suffice? (J. C., Toormina, NSW). • Most multimeters with an IRDA computer serial interface have an update rate which is far too slow for decoding infrared remote control protocols. plain about transistor failures, so we wonder if you have come across some low-spec devices. In fact, the VCEO rating (60V), referring to the transistor’s collector-emitter rating with the base open-circuit, is unrealistic, since transistors are virtually never operated in this condition. More realistic is the VCER rating (70V). Even so, the peak-to-peak swing at the output is less than 60V so unless the amplifier was being driven hard into clipping, the ratings are never likely to be exceeded. Over the years, the SC480 has proven to be a very reliable design. It is still available as a kit and is very popular There are bench meters such as the PicoTest M3510A (which we reviewed in April 2010) that can sample fast enough to decode the infrared protocol. The M3510A can take 50,000 readings per second and typical infrared protocols involve pulses a few Make new connections at Australia’s New Electronics Expo • See the latest in Assembly, Design, Components, Test and Repair electronics design & assembly expo TRADE ONLY Regist er Onl ine for FR EE ent ry • Australia’s only dedicated trade event for the electronics industry • Over 50 Exhibitors with the latest ideas and innovations • Plus the Surface Mount 2010 Conference in association with +61 3 9568 0599 • New technology and new products to improve your business +61 3 9676 2133 electronics design & assembly expo www.electronex.com.au Australian Technology Park - Sydney South 8-9 September 2010 siliconchip.com.au August 2010  95 Charge Controller Waveforms Not Quite Right I have built your Charge Controller For Lead-Acid Batteries, published in the April 2008 edition. You state in your circuit description that the PIC microcontroller delivers a square-wave signal from its pin 9 (PWM) output. However, as viewed on my scope, pin 9 is delivering something that looks more like a steep-sided sinewave. At the combined emitter outputs of transistors Q2 and Q3, the signal looks like a compromise between a square and a sinewave (sloping sides with flattish tops). Is this a problem and if so, how can I get a square-wave to appear? I have noticed when the charge controller is in circuit, the battery voltage (measured at the battery) jumps around quite a bit and remains below the default settings of 14.4V for bulk/ absorption and 13.8V for float. Is that to be expected or can the voltage be stabilised at the stated default levels? The charging current is provided by photovoltaic modhundred microseconds long. However, this meter costs more than some cheap digital oscilloscopes so it doesn’t really solve your problem. The Salae Logic analyser we reviewed in September 2009 is much closer to what you want. At the time, it cost US$149. It plugs into a computer and samples up to eight channels at a sufficient rate for what you want. The alternative is to buy a digital oscilloscope and these are becoming surprisingly affordable. UHF control system needs solar backup I recently purchased the 433MHz UHF Remote Switch kits (SILICON CHIP, January 2009). They were easy to assemble and they work perfectly. I thought that I may have been able to adapt them to my needs but I need a little assistance. With regard to the receiver unit, I need to install it in an area where there is no power supply (eg, garden sprinklers with latching solenoid) and I am using the momentary switching function for three seconds. I did test the receiver on a 9V battery and the 96  Silicon Chip ules. (C. B. Bundagen, NSW). • The waveforms may be a little distorted from their true square wave shape due to loading on pin 9 when the signal is close to 0V and at the 5V rail when Q3 and Q2 switch on. Similarly, the emitters of Q2 and Q3 may slew rate limit due to the transformer load applied via the series 3.3nF capacitor. As for the charging voltages, the battery voltage will be higher when charging and lower when not charging as current is switched on and off via Mosfet Q1. This is normal. You can reduce this effect if the 100% charging trimpot (VR1) is set higher than 1V to keep Q1 on during bulk charge. The voltage is varied depending on temperature and is dependent on the VR4 setting, ranging up to 50mV/°C above 20°C. This may not seem like much but on a hot day at (say) 35°C, the voltage will typically be 0.525V lower for the cut-off and float voltage if VR4 is set for 5V. whole circuit works OK. The problem here is that the power consumption of 7mA during idle soon depletes the battery. There are commercial brands of similar design UHF receivers being used in garden irrigation systems and they use a 9V battery. The battery is installed in a very compact receiver case, in a valve box with connection to a latching solenoid. The valve box, receiver unit and solenoid are remotely located well away from a power supply. The manufacturer claims that the battery will last for up to 12 months and they use the same latching solenoid as mine. I am hoping that you can advise me of an enhancement so that I can obtain the same performance. (N. S., via email). • Unfortunately, the receiver was not designed for low-power consumption as the UHF receiver needs to be permanently on so as to detect a signal from the transmitter at any time. Without drastic circuit and software changes, the circuit is not suited for low-power use. Garden irrigation systems can be designed for low current consump- tion whereby power is applied to the receiver once every 20s (say). The transmitter would be designed to send a signal for longer than this period when a change from the receiver is required. By doing this, the receiver receives the signal even if it is left unpowered most of the time. If you wish to use the existing UHF receiver, then perhaps a 12V SLA battery and a solar cell charger could be used for the supply. Batteries for a vintage portable radio I recently bought a Healing Golden Voice portable radio. It has no batteries and I don’t know what voltage it is. Is there any way of connecting a suitable power supply so I don’t have to use batteries? If not, where do I buy batteries to suit? It has two 3-pin plugs and one 2-pin plug. I did get some information from the Victorian Museum but am not sure how to interpret it. (T. V., Mt Martha, Vic). • As copied from a reply you received from the Victorian Museum, the supply voltages for the radio are 1.5V and 90V. The 2-pin plug plugged into the 1.5V “A” battery, while the two 3-pin plugs connected to a pair of 45V “B” batteries. The “A” battery was usually a long rectangular box with a number of 1.5V cells in parallel and the valve heater current drain was 300mA. The load on the “B” battery was 13mA. The “B” batteries would have been Eveready Minimax type 482, while the “A” battery would have been a type 742 or 745. These have not been made for many years. The 1.5V rail could be supplied using an alkaline D cell, with a D cell holder. The 45V at 13mA can be obtained by connecting five 9V batteries in series using battery snap connectors but they would not last long at a current of 13mA. We have not published a power supply for such a radio although if there was significant interest it would be a relatively simple exercise. Dremel engraver tool repair I have been asked to repair a Dremel engraver tool and it appears to have a Triac or thyristor in it as part of the speed control. Do you know what siliconchip.com.au Problem With Programmable Ignition System I have constructed the Programmable Ignition System, together with Knock Sensor, Ignition Coil Driver and Hand Controller (SILICON CHIP, March, April & May 2007). The problem is that as soon as power is connected, the unit goes straight into the oscillating mode. Using the Hand Controller, I can turn the oscillation off OK and it will stay that way while power is connected. However, as soon as I remove the power and power up again, the oscillation starts. This occurs regardless of the position of LK1. In addition, the display on the Hand Controller often shows incorrect characters, eg, “W” instead of an “S”, an “M” instead of an “I”, a “]” instead of a “Y”. The characters substituted are four apart on the ASCII table, suggesting one bit is being set when it shouldn’t be. I have carefully checked the main 3-pin TO-220 device would be used as the Triac or thyristor and would the electric motor actually run OK with the full 240V on it, even though it would spin its head off? (P. H., via email). • If your Dremel is a 240V tool with in-built speed control, the motor itself is likely to be rated to run at 180VAC. Running it at 240V may blow it. Without more information about the devices used in the speed control, we cannot nominate a substitute. GPS module availability I have two questions in reference to the GPS-Based Frequency Refer- board and the Hand Controller board for soldering errors, checked resistances between data lines etc and cannot find anything wrong. I believe there is an error in the preloaded software of the PIC controller and I need to know how I can get it fixed. (W. H., via email). • The oscillator mode can be set to off by powering up, turning off the oscillator and then changing the edge sense from the current setting of either high to low or low to high. You then change the edge sense back to the original setting again. Doing this will keep the oscillator off at power up. Changes to the display characters indicates interference or a connecting cable for the Hand Controller that is not earthed. Try earthing the shell of the cable. Also make sure the lead is well away from the high-tension wiring of the ignition.                       ReNew’s                                      ence (SILICON CHIP, March 2007). The     Garmin GPS 15L receiver module specified is no longer available. Is there an alternative? Is it possible to use a GlobalSat Technology EM-408 GPS in the GPS Frequency Reference, as it module in its place? (R. H., via email). does not provide a 1pps output. ad February 2010.pm6 1 1/03/2010, 2:36 PM that one the6thGarmin • It would appear ReNew 15L receiver module is no longer avail- Amplifier for a able in Australia, even though Garmin still has it listed as a current product knock detector I am currently working on a proon their US website. We contacted the local office of Garmin, which advised ject to make a listening device using that head office is no longer making it the Champ amplifier (SILICON CHIP, available here. However, you should February 1994) and the Pre-Champ still be able to order one online, from (July 1994) connected to an electret mic insert. one of the overseas distributors. The purpose of this project is to The GlobalSat Technology EM-408 is unfortunately not suitable for use make a knock detector to use while WARNING! SILICON CHIP magazine regularly describes projects which employ a mains power supply or produce high voltage. All such projects should be considered dangerous or even lethal if not used safely. Readers are warned that high voltage wiring should be carried out according to the instructions in the articles. When working on these projects use extreme care to ensure that you do not accidentally come into contact with mains AC voltages or high voltage DC. If you are not confident about working with projects employing mains voltages or other high voltages, you are advised not to attempt work on them. Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd disclaims any liability for damages should anyone be killed or injured while working on a project or circuit described in any issue of SILICON CHIP magazine. Devices or circuits described in SILICON CHIP may be covered by patents. SILICON CHIP disclaims any liability for the infringement of such patents by the manufacturing or selling of any such equipment. SILICON CHIP also disclaims any liability for projects which are used in such a way as to infringe relevant government regulations and by-laws. Advertisers are warned that they are responsible for the content of all advertisements and that they must conform to the Trade Practices Act 1974 or as subsequently amended and to any governmental regulations which are applicable. siliconchip.com.au August 2010  97 The Virtues Of Non-Inductive Resistors I am building the Studio 350 Power Amplifier (SILICON CHIP, January & February 2004) from individual parts (not a kit) and have a question about the eight 0.47Ω and one 6.8Ω 5W ceramic wirewound resistors. Would there be any advantage or disadvantage in using non-inductive 5W ceramic resistors in this module? Also, regarding the 330pF, 68pF and 10pF ceramic disc capacitors, would there be any advantage or disadvantage other than cost in using silvered mica capacitors in the Studio 350? With the 12nF 100V MKT polyester capacitor, could a 10nF or a 15nF be used instead without having any problems? (P. C., Whitebridge, NSW). • There is no disadvantage in using non-inductive resistors in any audio circuit but in the case of this amplifier there could be an advantage. In the past, we have specified paralleled carbon resistors instead of 5W wirewound emitter resistors, in two instances. The first was in another “life”, in the design of the Playmaster 60/60 (“Electronics Australia”, May, June & July 1986). In that case, the complete tuning vehicles. I have made the kit and it works well. However, I would like to improve it by filtering out the frequencies I don’t need. I was planning on making a bandpass filter and adding it to the circuit but after some research I noticed there are high and low-pass filters in the Pre-Champ. Can I change the value of the capacitors and resistors to roll-off stereo amplifier was on one very large PC board which included all the low-signal connections from the rear panel to the front-panel selector switch via unshielded copper tracks. Hence, it was important to keep any signal radiation from the amplifier’s emitter resistors to a minimum. The second instance involved both versions of the Ultra-LD Stereo Amplifier (SILICON CHIP, March & May 2000 and November 2001 to January 2002). These used ribbon cable for the input signal wiring to the selector switch and again, we wanted to minimise radiation from the amplifier’s output stage resistors. So unless you have unshielded low-level signal wiring in the same case as a big power amplifier, noninductive resistors should not normally be required. There is more to the story, though. First, some much older amplifier designs presented in other magazines were specified with non-inductive emitter resistors in the output stages to minimise the effects of inductance on the non-linearity of the transfer curve, ie, inductive resistors apparently made crossover distortion worse. We all values outside of 5-10kHz? (J. W., via email). • The filters can be changed. Use a 330nF capacitor instead of the 22µF in series with the 100Ω resistor for a high-pass filter at 5kHz. The .0015µF (1.5nF) capacitor across the 2.2kΩ resistor can be changed to 6.8nF to give a low-pass filter at 10kHz. Further roll-off below 5kHz can Notes & Errata Digital Audio Signal Generator (March-May 2010): there is a bug in the firmware. If the default sample rate is changed from 48kHz (ie, settings are written to Bank 0 after the sample rate is changed) then the generator will fail to start up. The solution is to reflash the dsPIC microcontroller (IC4) with a new version of the firmware (0420310C. hex). This revised firmware can be downloaded from the SILICON CHIP website. 98  Silicon Chip Dual Tracking Power Supply (JuneJuly 2010): the labels for V± and Ilim were swapped on the front panel artwork. Updated front panel artwork has been provided to the kit suppliers and is now available on the SILICON CHIP website. In addition, some constructors have found that VR7 has insufficient range to properly trim the V± reading. In this case, increase the value of its 68Ω shunt resistor or remove the shunt resistor entirely. cannot remember the specifics but it may have been more applicable to power Mosfets than to bipolar transistors. More recently, readers will be aware that we have done quite a lot of work with the PC board layout of recent amplifier designs to minimise or cancel the radiation of the magnetic fields produced by class-B output currents into the small signal stages. The best and most effective example of this is the double-sided PC board for the Ultra-LD Mk.2 Amplifier module featured in the August & September 2008 issues. In that case, we did not try the effect of substituting non-inductive emitter resistors. Possibly, we should have and we may try it in the future. So with respect to the Studio 350, it is possible that non-inductive resistors could reduce the rise in harmonic distortion at the higher frequencies. As far as the capacitors are concerned, the 68pF unit must be rated at 250V or higher. The dielectric is unimportant. The 12nF value is not critical; use 15nF if that is more easily obtainable. be achieved by changing the 0.1µF capacitor (100nF) at the input of the amplifier to a 560pF ceramic capacitor. GPS-synchronised clock queries I built the GPS Clock (March 2009) and I have a couple of queries. When testing the DC converter output voltage before installing the EM-408, the start­-up LED flashed once, then twice and the converter gave a voltage of 3.27V. However, this voltage did not cut out after two minutes as stated in the text and was still there after one hour. Why would that be? In addition, 3.27V seems a little low. How can I increase this to 3.3V or is it OK? The diagram of the EM-408 connections in Fig.1 seems to redrawn from the Users Manual but with the pins in the high position, which would indicate that the unit is mounted the other way up to your article. Consequently, the . . . continued on page 103 siliconchip.com.au STIC FANTAIDEA GIFT UDENTS FOR SFT ALL O S! AGE THEAMATEUR SCIENTIST An incredible CD with over 1000 classic projects from the pages of Scientific American, covering every field of science... NEW VERSION 4 – JUST RELEASED! GET THE LATEST VERSION NOW! Arguably THE most IMPORTANT collection of scientific projects ever put together! This is version 4, Super Science Fair Edition from the pages of Scientific American. As well as specific project material, the CDs contain hints and tips by experienced amateur scientists, details on building science apparatus, a large database of chemicals and so much more. ONLY 62 $ 00 PLUS $10 Pack and Post within Australia NZ P&P: $AU12.00, Elsewhere: $AU18.00 “A must for every science student, science teacher, science lab . . . or simply for those with an enquiring mind . . .” Just a tiny selection of the incredible range of projects: ! Build a seismograph to study earthquakes ! Make soap bubbles that last for months ! Monitor the health of local streams ! Preserve biological specimens ! Build a carbon dioxide laser ! Grow bacteria cultures safely at home ! Build a ripple tank to study wave phenomena ! Discover how plants grow in low gravity ! Do strange experiments with sound ! Use a hot wire to study the crystal structure of steel ! Extract and purify DNA in your kitchen !Create a laser hologram ! Study variable stars like a pro ! Investigate vortexes in water ! Cultivate slime moulds ! Study the flight efficiency of soaring birds ! How to make an Electret ! Construct fluid lenses ! Raise butterflies as experimental animals ! Study the physics of spinning tops ! Build an apparatus for studying chaotic systems ! Detect metals in air, liquids, or solids ! Photograph an ant's brain and nervous system ! Use magnets to make fluids into solids ! Measure the metabolism of an insect . . . ! and many, many more (a thousand more, in fact!) See the V2 review in SILICON CHIP, October 2004. . . or read on line at siliconchip.com.au This is the ALL-NEW Version 4 . . . it’s even BETTER! HERE’S HOW TO ORDER YOUR COPY: BY PHONE:* (02) 9939 3295 9-5 Mon-Fri BY FAX:# <at> (02) 9939 2648 24 Hours 7 Days BY EMAIL:# silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au 24 Hours 7 Days BY MAIL:# BY PAYPAL:# PO Box 139, Collaroy NSW 2097 silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au 24 Hours 7 Days * Please have your credit card handy! # Don’t forget to include your name, address, phone no and credit card details. BY INTERNET:^ siliconchip.com.au 24 Hours 7 Days ^ You will be prompted for required information There’s also a handy order form inside this issue. Exclusive in SILICON Australia to: CHIP siliconchip.com.au siliconchip.com.au August 2010  99 WANT TO SAVE 10%? S C (PRINT EDITION) AUTOMATICALLY QUALIFY FOR REFERENCE $ave SUBSCRIBERS* CHIP BOOKSHOP 10% A 10% DISCOUNT ON ALL BOOK PURCHASES! SILICON ILICON HIP (*Does not apply to website orders) SELF ON AUDIO by Douglas Self 2nd Edition 2006 $69.00 PROGRAMMING and CUSTOMIZING THE PICAXE By David Lincoln (2nd Ed, 2011) $65.00 See Review A great aid when wrestling with applications for the PICAXE series of microcontrollers, at beginner, intermediate and advanced April 2011 levels. Every electronics class, school and library should have a copy, A collection of 35 classic magazine articles offering a dependable methodology for designing audio power amplifiers to improve performance at every point without significantly increasing cost. Includes compressors/limiters, hybrid bipolar/FET amps, electronic switching and more. 474 pages in paperback. along with anyone who works with PICAXEs. 300 pages in paperback SMALL SIGNAL AUDIO DESIGN By Douglas Self – First Edition 2010 $88.00 PIC IN PRACTICE The latest from the Guru of audio. Explains audio concepts in easy-to-understand language with plenty of examples and reasoning. Inspiration for audio designers, superb background for audio enthusiasts and especially where it comes to component peculiarities and limitations. Expensive? Yes. Value for money? YES! Highly recommended. 558 pages in paperback. by D W Smith. 2nd Edition - published 2006 $60.00 Based on popular short courses on the PIC, for professionals, students and teachers. Can be used at a variety of levels. An ideal introduction to the world of microcontrollers. 255 pages in paperback. AUDIO POWER AMPLIFIER DESIGN HANDBOOK PIC MICROCONTROLLER – your personal introduc- by Douglas Self – 5th Edition 2009 $81.00 tory course By John Morton 3rd edition 2005. $60.00 "The Bible" on audio power amplifiers. Many revisions and updates to the previous edition and now has an extra three chapters covering Class XD, Power Amp Input Systems and Input Processing and Auxiliarly Subsystems. Not cheap and not a book for the beginner but if you want the best reference on Audio Power Amps, you want this one! 463 pages in paperback. A unique and practical guide to getting up and running with the PIC. It assumes no knowledge of microcontrollers – ideal introduction for students, teachers, technicians and electronics enthusiasts. Revised 3rd edition focuses entirely on re-programmable flash PICs such as 16F54, 16F84 12F508 and 12F675. 226 pages in paperback. PRACTICAL GUIDE TO SATELLITE TV OP AMPS FOR EVERYONE By Garry Cratt – Latest (7th) Edition 2008 $49.00 By Carter & Mancini – 3RD EDITION $100.00 Written in Australia, for Australian conditions by one of Australia's foremost satellite TV experts. If there is anything you wanted to know about setting up a satellite TV system, (including what you can't do!) it's sure to be covered in this 176-page paperback book. Substantially updates coverage for low-speed and high-speed applications, and provides step-by-step walk-throughs for design and selection of op amps. Huge 648 pages! PROGRAMMING 32-bit MICROCONTROLLERS IN C By Luci di Jasio (2008) $79.00 NEWNES GUIDE TO TV & VIDEO TECHNOLOGY By KF Ibrahim 4th Edition (Published 2007) $49.00 Subtitled Exploring the PIC32, a Microchip insider tells all on this powerful PIC! Focuses on examples and exercises that show how to solve common, real-world design problems quickly. Includes handy checklists. FREE CD-ROM includes source code in C, the Microchip C30 compiler, and MPLAB SIM. 400 pages paperback. It's back! Provides a full and comprehensive coverage of video and television technology including HDTV and DVD. Starts with fundamentals so is ideal for students but covers in-depth technologies such as Blu-ray, DLP, Digital TV, etc so is also perfect for engineers. 600+ pages in paperback. USING UBUNTU LINUX RF CIRCUIT DESIGN by J Rolfe & A Edney – published 2007 $27.00 by Chris Bowick, Second Edition, 2008. $63.00 Ubuntu Linux is a free and easy-to-use operating system, a viable alternative to Windows and Mac OS. Introduces Ubuntu, tells how to set it up, covers the various Open Office applications and gives troubleshooting hints and tips. Highly recommended. 222 pages in paperback DVD PLAYERS AND DRIVES by K.F. Ibrahim. Published 2003. $71.00 A guide to DVD technology and applications, with particular focus on design issues and pitfalls, maintenance and repair. Ideal for engineers, technicians, students of consumer electronics and sales and installation staff. 319 pages in paperback. The classic RF circuit design book. RF circuit design is now more important that ever in the wireless world. In most of the wireless devices that we use there is an RF component – this book tells how to design and integrate in a very practical fashion. 244 pages in paperback. PRACTICAL RF HANDBOOK See Review Feb 2004 by Ian Hickman. 4th edition 2006 $61.00 A guide to RF design for engineers, technicians, students and enthusiasts. Covers key topics in RF: analog design principles, transmission lines, couplers, transformers, amplifiers, oscillators, modulation, transmitters and receivers, propagation and antennas. 279 pages in paperback. ELECTRIC MOTORS AND DRIVES PRACTICAL VARIABLE SPEED DRIVES & POWER ELECTRONICS Se By Austin Hughes - Third edition 2006 $51.00 Intended for non-specialist users of electric motors and drives, filling the gap between academic texts and general "handbooks". Explores all of the widely-used modern types of motor and drive including conventional & brushless DC, induction motors, steppers, servos, synchronous and reluctance. 384 pages, soft cover. e Review Feb An essential reference for engineers and anyone who wishes 2003 to design or use variable speed drives for induction motors. by Malcolm Barnes. 1st Ed, Feb 2003. $73.00 286 pages in soft cover. BUILD YOUR OWN ELECTRIC MOTORCYCLE AC MACHINES by Carl Vogel. Published 2009. $40.00 By Jim Lowe Published 2006 $66.00 Applicable to Australian trades-level courses including NE10 AC Machines, NE12 Synchronous Machines and the AC part of NE30 Electric Motor Control and Protection. Covering polyphase induction motors, single-phase motors, synchronous machines and polyphase motor starting. 160 pages in paperback. Alternative fuel expert Carl Vogel gives you a hands-on guide with the latest technical information and easy-to-follow instructions for building a two-wheeled electric vehicle – from a streamlined scooter to a full-sized motorcycle. 384 pages in soft cover. NOTE: ALL PRICES ARE PLUS P&P – AUSTRALIA ONLY: $10.00 per order; OR FAX (24/7) OR NZ – $12.00 PER BOOK; PAYPAL (24/7) REST OF WORLD $18.00 PER BOOK PHONE – (9-5, Mon-Fri) eMAIL (24/7) OR To Call (02) 9939 3295 with Your order and card details to Use your PayPal account silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au Place 100  S ilicon C hip with order & credit card details (02) 9939 2648 with all details silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au with order & credit card details Your Or use the handy order form on P105 of this issue Order: 1-13 See Review March 2010 OR MAIL Your order to PO Box 139 siliconchip.com.au Collaroy NSW 2097 *ALL TITLES SUBJECT TO AVAILABILITY. PRICES VALID FOR MONTH OF MAGAZINE ISSUE ONLY. ALL PRICES INCLUDE GST WANT TO SAVE 10%? S C (PRINT EDITION) AUTOMATICALLY QUALIFY FOR REFERENCE $ave SUBSCRIBERS* CHIP BOOKSHOP 10% A 10% DISCOUNT ON ALL BOOK PURCHASES! SILICON ILICON HIP (*Does not apply to website orders) SELF ON AUDIO PROGRAMMING and CUSTOMIZING THE PICAXE By David Lincoln (2nd Ed, 2011) $65.00 by Douglas Self 2nd Edition 2006 $69.00 See A collection of 35 classic magazine articles offering a dependable methodology for designing audio power amplifiers to improve performance at every point without significantly increasing cost. Includes compressors/limiters, hybrid bipolar/FET amps, electronic switching and more. 474 pages in paperback. Review A great aid when wrestling with applications for the PICAXE series of microcontrollers, at beginner, intermediate and advanced April 2011 levels. Every electronics class, school and library should have a copy, along with anyone who works with PICAXEs. 300 pages in paperback SMALL SIGNAL AUDIO DESIGN PIC IN PRACTICE By Douglas Self – First Edition 2010 $88.00 by D W Smith. 2nd Edition - published 2006 $60.00 The latest from the Guru of audio. Explains audio concepts in easy-to-understand language with plenty of examples and reasoning. Inspiration for audio designers, superb background for audio enthusiasts and especially where it comes to component peculiarities and limitations. Expensive? Yes. Value for money? YES! Highly recommended. 558 pages in paperback. Based on popular short courses on the PIC, for professionals, students and teachers. Can be used at a variety of levels. An ideal introduction to the world of microcontrollers. 255 pages in paperback. PIC MICROCONTROLLER – your personal introduc- AUDIO POWER AMPLIFIER DESIGN HANDBOOK tory course By John Morton 3rd edition 2005. $60.00 by Douglas Self – 5th Edition 2009 $81.00 A unique and practical guide to getting up and running with the PIC. It assumes no knowledge of microcontrollers – ideal introduction for students, teachers, technicians and electronics enthusiasts. Revised 3rd edition focuses entirely on re-programmable flash PICs such as 16F54, 16F84 12F508 and 12F675. 226 pages in paperback. "The Bible" on audio power amplifiers. Many revisions and updates to the previous edition and now has an extra three chapters covering Class XD, Power Amp Input Systems and Input Processing and Auxiliarly Subsystems. Not cheap and not a book for the beginner but if you want the best reference on Audio Power Amps, you want this one! 463 pages in paperback. OP AMPS FOR EVERYONE PRACTICAL GUIDE TO SATELLITE TV By Carter & Mancini – 3RD EDITION $100.00 Substantially updates coverage for low-speed and high-speed applications, and provides step-by-step walk-throughs for design and selection of op amps. Huge 648 pages! By Garry Cratt – Latest (7th) Edition 2008 $49.00 Written in Australia, for Australian conditions by one of Australia's foremost satellite TV experts. If there is anything you wanted to know about setting up a satellite TV system, (including what you can't do!) it's sure to be covered in this 176-page paperback book. PROGRAMMING 32-bit MICROCONTROLLERS IN C By Luci di Jasio (2008) $79.00 NEWNES GUIDE TO TV & VIDEO TECHNOLOGY Subtitled Exploring the PIC32, a Microchip insider tells all on this powerful PIC! Focuses on examples and exercises that show how to solve common, real-world design problems quickly. Includes handy checklists. FREE CD-ROM includes source code in C, the Microchip C30 compiler, and MPLAB SIM. 400 pages paperback. By KF Ibrahim 4th Edition (Published 2007) $49.00 It's back! Provides a full and comprehensive coverage of video and television technology including HDTV and DVD. Starts with fundamentals so is ideal for students but covers in-depth technologies such as Blu-ray, DLP, Digital TV, etc so is also perfect for engineers. 600+ pages in paperback. USING UBUNTU LINUX by J Rolfe & A Edney – published 2007 $27.00 RF CIRCUIT DESIGN Ubuntu Linux is a free and easy-to-use operating system, a viable alternative to Windows and Mac OS. Introduces Ubuntu, tells how to set it up, covers the various Open Office applications and gives troubleshooting hints and tips. Highly recommended. 222 pages in paperback DVD PLAYERS AND DRIVES by K.F. Ibrahim. Published 2003. $71.00 A guide to DVD technology and applications, with particular focus on design issues and pitfalls, maintenance and repair. Ideal for engineers, technicians, students of consumer electronics and sales and installation staff. 319 pages in paperback. by Chris Bowick, Second Edition, 2008. $63.00 The classic RF circuit design book. RF circuit design is now more important that ever in the wireless world. In most of the wireless devices that we use there is an RF component – this book tells how to design and integrate in a very practical fashion. 244 pages in paperback. See Review Feb 2004 PRACTICAL RF HANDBOOK by Ian Hickman. 4th edition 2006 $61.00 A guide to RF design for engineers, technicians, students and enthusiasts. Covers key topics in RF: analog design principles, transmission lines, couplers, transformers, amplifiers, oscillators, modulation, transmitters and receivers, propagation and antennas. 279 pages in paperback. ELECTRIC MOTORS AND DRIVES By Austin Hughes - Third edition 2006 $51.00 PRACTICAL VARIABLE SPEED DRIVES & POWER ELECTRONICS Se Intended for non-specialist users of electric motors and drives, filling the gap between academic texts and general "handbooks". Explores all of the widely-used modern types of motor and drive including conventional & brushless DC, induction motors, steppers, servos, synchronous and reluctance. 384 pages, soft cover. e Review Feb An essential reference for engineers and anyone who wishes 2003 to design or use variable speed drives for induction motors. by Malcolm Barnes. 1st Ed, Feb 2003. $73.00 286 pages in soft cover. AC MACHINES BUILD YOUR OWN ELECTRIC MOTORCYCLE By Jim Lowe Published 2006 $66.00 Applicable to Australian trades-level courses including NE10 AC Machines, NE12 Synchronous Machines and the AC part of NE30 Electric Motor Control and Protection. Covering polyphase induction motors, singlephase motors, synchronous machines and polyphase motor starting. 160 pages in paperback. by Carl Vogel. Published 2009. $40.00 Alternative fuel expert Carl Vogel gives you a hands-on guide with the latest technical information and easy-to-follow instructions for building a two-wheeled electric vehicle – from a streamlined scooter to a full-sized motorcycle. 384 pages in soft cover. NOTE: ALL PRICES ARE PLUS P&P – AUSTRALIA ONLY: $10.00 per order; eMAIL (24/7) To silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au Place siliconchip.com.au with order & credit card details Your Order: 1-13 See Review March 2010 OR FAX (24/7) Your order and card details to (02) 9939 2648 with all details OR NZ – $12.00 PER BOOK; PAYPAL (24/7) Use your PayPal account silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au OR REST OF WORLD $18.00 PER BOOK PHONE – (9-5, Mon-Fri) OR MAIL Your order to PO Box 139 Call (02) 9939 3295 with 2010  101 NSW 2097 with order & credit card detailsAugustCollaroy Or use the handy order form on P85 of this issue *ALL TITLES SUBJECT TO AVAILABILITY. PRICES VALID FOR MONTH OF MAGAZINE ISSUE ONLY. ALL PRICES INCLUDE GST MARKET CENTRE Cash in your surplus gear. Advertise it here in SILICON CHIP ELNEC IC PROGRAMMERS High quality Realistic prices Free software updates Large range of adaptors Windows 95/98/Me/NT/2k/XP C O N T R O L S Tough times demand innovative solutions! ANSI C compilers, Windows IDE AVR, TMS430, ARM7/ARM9 68HC08, 68HC11, 68HC12 GRANTRONICS PTY LTD www.grantronics.com.au FOR SALE PCBs MADE, ONE OR MANY. Any format, hobbyists welcome. Sesame Electronics Phone (02) 9593 1025. sesame<at>sesame.com.au www.sesame.com.au terrystransistors.com.au: genuine MJE15030/31 BD139/40 2SA970 BF469/470 MJE340/50 MJL4302A MJL4281A ON<at>$9.20 MJL21193/4 MJL1302A MJL3281A 2SA1085 MPSA42 Cheap postage. LEDs! Nichia, Cree and other brand name LEDs at excellent prices. LED drivers, including ultra-reliable linear driver options. Many other interesting and hard-to-find electronic items! www.ledsales.com.au RCS RADIO/DESIGN is at 41 Arlewis St, Chester Hill 2162, NSW Australia and has all the published PC boards from SC, EA, ETI, HE, AEM & others. Ph (02) 9738 0330. sales<at>rcsradio.com. au; www.rcsradio.com.au 102  Silicon Chip Hurry - stocks are limited. Call Avcomm now - (02) 9939 4377 SPK360 3/5/06used1:10 PM world-wide Page 1 Made in Australia, by OEMs splat-sc.com For more details visit www.avcomm.com.au Battery Packs & Chargers 20 years experience! HI-FISPEAKER REPAIRS YOUR EXPERT SPEAKER REPAIR SPECIALISTS Specialising in UK, US and Danish brands. Speakerbits are your vintage, rare and collectable speaker repair experts. Foam surrounds, voice coils, complete recone kits and more. Original OEM parts for Scan-Speak, Dynaudio, Tannoy, JBL, ElectroVoice and others! Siomar Battery Engineering SPK360 IMAGECRAFT C COMPILERS YYes, es, it’s it’s ttrue! rue! DDon’t on’t llet et iits ts ttiny iny ssize ize ffool ool yyou. ou. TThis his ppowerhouse owerhouse receiver receiver ccovers overs tthe he AAM, M, FFM, M, LLW W aand nd eentire ntire SSW W bbands ands ffrom rom 33.5 5 to to3030MHz MHz – –anand d hahas s gegenuine nuine digdigital ital sigsignal nal prprocessing! ocessing! Exclusive to Avcomm, the Tecsun PL-310 normally sells for $90.00 but if you say you saw it in SILICON CHIP, Avcomm will give you 10% off (June/July only)! CLEVERSCOPE USB OSCILLOSCOPES 2 x 100MSa/s 10bit inputs + trigger 100MHz bandwidth 8 x digital inputs 4M samples/input Sig-gen + spectrum analyser Windows 98/Me/NT/2k/XP WOW! A QUALITY WOW! QUALITY DSP DSP HFF C H COMMUNICATIONS OMMUNICATIONS R ECEIVER FFOR OR 1 0% O FF? RECEIVER 10% OFF? www.batterybook.com Phone (08) 9302 5444 tel: 03 9647 7000 www.speakerbits.com SPEAKERWORKS: technically qualified specialist (45 years) vintage, professional, hifi speaker repairs. Original/ custom-made re-cones, diaphragms, modifications and upgrades. swa<at> speakerworks.com.au KINSTEN: Make your own PCBs. Presensitised PCBs, chemicals, tools and Kynar wire. Phone 08 6465 9799 or order at www.kinsten.com.au HMI and PLC in One! Comfile Technologies CuTouch (CT1721-C). Also available in Black and White screen for viewing outdoors. The CuTOUCH comes integrated with industrial controller, Blue & White Graphic LCD, touch-input processor, opto-isolated I/O boards, analog inputs & outputs, and Plug-n-Play support for Relay boards. 64 I/O plus 6 channels PWM or DAC, 4 external interrupts, and 2 16-bit counters. The CuTOUCH units can be programmed in BASIC or Relay Ladder Logic using the Cubloc Studio Software available from our website. Applications can range anywhere from home automation to industrial gas monitoring. By providing easy-to-use GUI tools, Comfile Technology guarantees you a competitive edge over any other touch screen products on the market today. Replace outdated PLC, push-buttons, siliconchip.com.au VIDEO - AUDIO - PC distribution amps - splitters digital standards converters - tbc's switchers - cables - adaptors genlockers - scan converters bulk vga cable - wallplates DVS5c & DVS5s High Performance Video / S-Video and Audio Splitters MD12 Media Distribution Amplifier QUEST ® Quest AV® VGA Splitter VGS2 HQ VGA Cables AWP1 A-V Wallplate Come to the specialists... QUESTRONIX ® Quest Electronics® Pty Limited abn 83 003 501 282 t/a Questronix Products, Specials & Pricelist at www.questronix.com.au fax (02) 4341 2795 phone (02) 4343 1970 email: questav<at>questronix.com.au small LCD combo with 1 single CuTOUCH™. Many other Windows CE & XP PLCs, core modules and accessories. Call for info: sales<at>ozcomfile.com.au or 1300 208 570. www.ozcomfile.com.au WANTED CUSTOMERS WANTED: Truscotts Electronic World – large range of semiconductors and passive components for industry, hobbyist and amateur projects including Drew Diamond. 27 The Mall, South Croydon, Melbourne. Phone (03) 9723 3860. sales<at>electronicworld. com.au KIT ASSEMBLY KEITH RIPPON KIT ASSEMBLY & REPAIR: * Australia & New Zealand; * Small production runs. Phone Keith 0409 662 794. keith.rippon<at>gmail.com siliconchip.com.au Ask SILICON CHIP – continued from page 98 101 numbering does not align with the PC board, ie, pin 5 (Vcc) should be on the left of the diagram. The connections to the PC board seem correct, as in Fig.2. Am I correct? (N. U., via email). • The cutout on initial start-up was subsequently changed to “forever” rather than the two minutes mentioned in the article. The reason for this is that from a dead cold start (ie, the module has not been used for many months), it will take the module up to 12 minutes to receive a complete set of satellite position data before it could report “ready”. This issue only applies to the first start-up of the clock. On a normal synchronisation (while the clock is running), the micro will now wait for four minutes before declaring “no signal”. It will then will retry 10 more times with a 4-hour gap between repeat attempts. A supply of 3.27V is fine and is well within tolerances. The module will happily run at anywhere from 3.1V to 3.5V. Fig.2 is correct – the lefthand wire of the module (viewed from the top), which is pin 5, should go to the lefthand solder point on the board (Vcc). The EM-408 pin diagram on Fig.1 is shown with the module upside down (the PC board designation is actually the EM-408’s board). Unnecessary mods to Schoolies amplifier I have recently assembled a pair of 20W Schoolies amplifier modules. (SILICON CHIP, December 2004) and I believe there is a small design problem with your additional components that differ from the manufacturer’s data sheet. I made some measurements because the speaker protection unit I have started to activate. I discovered that 1.7V was hanging off the output. When I removed your additional components that voltage rail imbalance corrected itself. These are the changes I made: (1) 10Ω resistor replaced with wire link; (2) 330pF capacitor removed; (3) 22µF capacitor replaced with what I had, a 100µF 25V, for AC grounding; and (4) 1kΩ resistor in series with pin 1 replaced with wire link. I also removed or bypassed the 2.2µF 16V capacitor from the circuit. Now let’s get to the Zobel Network: it’s most certainly not working for these speakers and the 1Ω 1W resistor has been removed. This amplifier is now starting to sound much better. With some good-quality filter capacitors in the power supply and a good-quality transformer, it will be a lot better then when I started. You can always improve on a design. (R. M., via email). • None of your modifications will make the amplifier better or improve its sound quality. Removing the 2.2µF input capacitor means that any residual DC from your program source will be coupled though the amplifier to the speakers – that may be why your loudspeaker protector is operating. Removing the 1kΩ and 330pF capacitors will make the amplifier more prone to RF breakthrough and certainly will not improve the audio response – it’s already flat to 100kHz. The original article explained the reason for the inclusion of virtually every component in the circuit – we would not have included them if they weren’t necessary. In fact, making arbitrary alterations to any amplifier circuit will generally cause the performance to be worse. Unless you have the test gear to check the effect of any alterations, you are working in the dark. Our suggestion is that you restore everything SC to the original circuit. Advertising rates for these pages: Classified ads: $29.50 (incl. GST) for up to 20 words plus 85 cents for each additional word. Display ads: $54.50 (incl. GST) per column centimetre (max. 10cm). Closing date: 5 weeks prior to month of sale. To book, email the text to silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au and include your name, address & credit card details, or fax (02) 9939 2648, or phone (02) 9939 3295. August 2010  103 Do you eat, breathe and sleep TECHNOLOGY? Opportunities exist for experienced Sales Professionals & Store Management across Australia & NZ Jaycar Electronics is a rapidly growing, Australian owned, international retailer with more than 60 stores in Australia and New Zealand. Due to our aggressive expansion program we are seeking dedicated sales professionals to join our retail team to assist us in achieving our goals. We pride ourselves on technical expertise from our staff. Do you think that the following statements describe you? Please put a tick in the boxes that do:  Knowledge of core electronics, particularly at a component level  Retail experience, highly regarded  Assemble projects or kits yourself for your car, computer, audio etc  Have energy, enthusiasm and a personality that enjoys helping people  Opportunities for future advancement and development  Why not do something you love and get paid for it? Please email us your applicaton & CV in PDF format, including location preference. We offer a competitive salary, sales incentive and have a generous staff purchase policy. Applications should be emailed to jobs <at> jaycar.com.au Jaycar Electronics is an Equal Opportunity Employer & actively promotes staff from within the organisation. Advertising Index Altronics..................................... 76-79 Amateur Scientist CD...................... 99 Aust. Valve Audio Transformers..... 102 Av-Comm...................................... 102 Alternative Technology Assoc......... 97 Australasian Exhibitions.................. 95 Cleverscope.................................... 27 Dick Smith Electronics............... 18-19 Emona Instruments......................... 45 Futurlec............................................. 6 Grantronics................................... 102 Harbuch Electronics........................ 15 Hare & Forbes..............................OBC HK Wentworth Pty Ltd....................... 9 Instant PCBs................................. 102 Jaycar............................IFC,49-56,104 Keith Rippon................................. 103 Kinsten Pty Ltd.............................. 102 Kitstop........................................... 103 LED Sales..................................... 102 Microgram Computers.................. IBC Ocean Controls............................... 43 OzComfile..................................... 102 into RF? DOWNLOAD OUR CATALOG at There’s something to suit every radio frequency fan in the SILICON CHIP reference bookshop RF Circuit Design – by Chris Bowick A new edition of this classic RF design text - tells how to design and integrate RF components into virtually any circuitry. $ PCBCART....................................... 15 www.iinet.net.au/~worcom Quest Electronics.......................... 103 WORLDWIDE ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS PO Box 631, Hillarys, WA 6923 Ph: (08) 9307 7305 Fax: (08) 9307 7309 Email: worcom<at>iinet.net.au RF Modules................................... 104 RCS Radio.................................... 102 Screenscope..................................... 3 Sesame Electronics...................... 102 Silicon Chip Binders........................ 69 Silicon Chip Silicon Chip Bookshop........... 100-101 Silicon Chip Order Form................. 25 Siomar Battery Engineering....... 7,102 Circuit Ideas Wanted Soundlabs Group.............................. 9 – by Ian Hickman A reference work for technicians, engineers, students and the more specialised enthusiast. Covers all the key topics in RF that you $ need to understand 90 Do you have a good circuit idea? If so, sketch it out, write a brief description of its operation & send it to us. Splat Controls............................... 102 Practical Guide To Satellite TV Provided your idea is workable & original, we’ll publish it in Circuit Notebook & you’ll make some money. We pay up to $100 for a good circuit idea or you could win some test gear. 75 Practical RF H’book – by Garry Cratt The reference written by an Aussie for Aussie conditions.Everything you need to know. $ 49 You’ll find many more technical titles in the SILICON CHIP reference bookshop – see elsewhere in this issue 104  Silicon Chip Silicon Chip Publications, PO Box 139, Collaroy, NSW 2097. Speakerbits................................... 103 Speakerworks............................... 102 Tenrod............................................... 5 Terry’s Transistors......................... 102 Truscotts Electronic World............. 103 Wagner Electronics......................... 47 Wiltronics........................................ 33 Worldwide Elect. Components...... 104 PC Boards Printed circuit boards for SILICON CHIP designs can be obtained from RCS Radio Pty Ltd. Phone (02) 9738 0330. Fax (02) 9738 0331. siliconchip.com.au MicroGram Computers ? w e N s ’ t a h W USB Endoscope HDMI Switch 150 Disc CD/DVD Carousel USB Temperature & Humidity Sensor Cat. 3747-7 $119 Cat No. 23055-7 $89 Cat. 6303-7 $289 Cat No. 17090-7 $299 Industrial LCD Arm USB to VGA Adapter Voice Activated Universal Remote Remote IP Power Switch Cat. 4704-7 $159 Cat. 15179-7 $197 Cat. 9526-7 $250 Cat. 3140-7 $299 $390.40 IP68 Industrial Mouse VGA to HDMI Converter Mini Keyboard with Touchpad USB HD to NAS Adapter The Standalone Skype phone has been pre-loaded Cat 10286 Price with Skype software. Therefore, you have access $199 to all the features and functions of Skype that were provided by your computer previously. Simply connect to a wireless network and it’s ready to go! Cat. 1008414-7 $35 Cat No 23066-7 $149 Cat. 8751-7 $142 Cat. 7112-7 $119 USB 3.0 HD Cases & Adapters Cat. No. Description Cat 7095 7109-7 7095-7 7098-7 USB 3.0 External HD Case 2.5” SATA USB 3.0 External HD Case 3.5” SATA USB 3.0 External HD Dock 2.5” or 3.5” SATA 7096-7 7097-7 USB 3.0 ExpressCard 2 Port (for notebooks) USB 3.0 PCIe Card 2 Port (for desktops) Price $79 $99 $89 Cat 7096 $65 $65 Digital Microscope Cat. No. 3769-7 For those innovative, unique, interesting, hard to find products An amazing, easy to use handheld digital microscope with USB output interface. High resolution magnification at your fingertips! Detailed examination of any area you choose. Cat 3769 Price Cordless Standalone Skype Phone Cat. No. 10286-7 N ot s u r e w h i c h p r o d u c t y o u n e e d ? C a l l u s to d a y fo r fr i e n d l y ad v i c e ! www.mg ra m.com.a u t r o p p u S y c a Leg Serial & Parallel Cards Cat. No. Description 2297-7 2658-7 2315-7 RS232 ISA Card RS422/485 ISA Card Parallel ISA Card 3021-7 2672-7 2724-7 RS232 Universal PCI Card RS422/485 PCI Card Parallel PCI Card 2726-7 2737-7 RS232 PCMCIA Card Parallel PCMCIA Card 2456-7 2405-7 2406-7 RS232 & Parallel PCIe Card RS232 ExpressCard Parallel ExpressCard 2920-7 2853-7 2729-7 USB to RS232 USB to RS422/485 USB to Parallel Cat 2297 Cat 3021 LGA775 Motherboard with ISA Dual Serial to Ethernet ISA FDD & HD Controller IDE Removable HD Kit Cat. 17115-7 $649 Cat. 15142-7 $359.00 Cat. 2055-7 $59 Cat. 6615-7 $39 USB Analog TV Tuner ISA 16ch Digital I/O Card PCI Watchdog Timer Card 56k External Modem Cat. 3527-7 $79 Cat. ACL7225-7 $489 Cat. 17070-7 $299 Cat. 10089-7 $79 Parallel Print Server PCI to PCMCIA adapter EPROM Programmer PCI Video Card FX5200 Cat. 11293-7 $159 Cat. 6539-7 $89 Cat. 3655-7 $499 Cat. 3671-7 $129 $69 $199 $39 $72 $229 $49 Cat 2726 Cat 2405 Cat 2920 Price $239 $199 $149 $89 $139 $59 $249 $49 MicroGram Computers siliconchip.com.au a s k <at>m g r a m . c o m . a u Unique IT Solutions 1800 625 777 ask<at>mgram.com.au August 2010  105 www.mgram.com.au All prices subject to change without notice. For current pricing visit our website. Pictures are indicative only. SHORE AD/MGRM0710 1 800 6 25 777